Add 2010 to copyright years.
[bpt/emacs.git] / doc / misc / org.texi
CommitLineData
4009494e
GM
1\input texinfo
2@c %**start of header
db78a8cb 3@setfilename ../../info/org
a7808fba 4@settitle The Org Manual
4009494e 5
72d803ad 6@set VERSION 6.33x
a351880d 7@set DATE November 2009
4009494e 8
4009494e 9@c Version and Contact Info
dbc28aaa 10@set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
4009494e
GM
11@set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
12@set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
dbc28aaa
CD
13@set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
14@set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
4009494e
GM
15@c %**end of header
16@finalout
17
18@c Macro definitions
c8d0cf5c
CD
19@iftex
20@c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
21@end iftex
22@macro Ie {}
23I.e.,
24@end macro
25@macro ie {}
26i.e.,
27@end macro
28@macro Eg {}
29E.g.,
30@end macro
31@macro eg {}
32e.g.,
33@end macro
4009494e
GM
34
35@c Subheadings inside a table.
36@macro tsubheading{text}
37@ifinfo
38@subsubheading \text\
39@end ifinfo
40@ifnotinfo
41@item @b{\text\}
42@end ifnotinfo
43@end macro
44
45@copying
c8d0cf5c 46This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
4009494e 47
114f9c96 48Copyright @copyright{} 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010 Free Software Foundation
4009494e
GM
49
50@quotation
51Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
d60b1ba1 52under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
4009494e
GM
53any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
54Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
47271179
GM
55and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
56is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
4009494e 57
6f093307
GM
58(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
59modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
60developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
5b14aca9
GM
61
62This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
63Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
64separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
65license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
4009494e
GM
66@end quotation
67@end copying
68
5dc584b5
KB
69@dircategory Emacs
70@direntry
71* Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
72@end direntry
73
4009494e 74@titlepage
a7808fba 75@title The Org Manual
4009494e
GM
76
77@subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
78@author by Carsten Dominik
79
80@c The following two commands start the copyright page.
81@page
82@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
83@insertcopying
84@end titlepage
85
86@c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
87@contents
88
89@ifnottex
90@node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
91@top Org Mode Manual
92
93@insertcopying
94@end ifnottex
95
96@menu
97* Introduction:: Getting started
a7808fba 98* Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
4009494e
GM
99* Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
100* Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
a7808fba 101* TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
4009494e 102* Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
a7808fba
CD
103* Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
104* Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
a351880d 105* Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
a7808fba 106* Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
a351880d 107* Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
4009494e 108* Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
a7808fba 109* Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
4009494e 110* Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
a50253cc 111* Hacking:: How to hack your way around
7006d207 112* MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
a7808fba
CD
113* History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
114* Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
4009494e 115* Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
c8d0cf5c 116* Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
4009494e
GM
117
118@detailmenu
119 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
120
121Introduction
122
a7808fba
CD
123* Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
124* Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
125* Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
4009494e 126* Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
dbc28aaa 127* Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
4009494e
GM
128
129Document Structure
130
a7808fba
CD
131* Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
132* Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
4009494e
GM
133* Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
134* Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
135* Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
4009494e
GM
136* Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
137* Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
138* Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
c8d0cf5c 139* Blocks:: Folding blocks
55e0839d 140* Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
a7808fba 141* Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
4009494e 142
4009494e
GM
143Tables
144
145* Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
c8d0cf5c 146* Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
4009494e 147* Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
a7808fba
CD
148* Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
149* The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
c8d0cf5c 150* Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
4009494e
GM
151
152The spreadsheet
153
154* References:: How to refer to another field or range
155* Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
156* Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
157* Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
158* Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
159* Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
160* Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
161* Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
162
163Hyperlinks
164
a7808fba 165* Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
4009494e
GM
166* Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
167* External links:: URL-like links to the world
168* Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
a7808fba 169* Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
4009494e
GM
170* Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
171* Search options:: Linking to a specific location
172* Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
4009494e
GM
173
174Internal links
175
a7808fba 176* Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
4009494e 177
a7808fba 178TODO Items
4009494e
GM
179
180* TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
181* TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
dbc28aaa 182* Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
4009494e
GM
183* Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
184* Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
185* Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
186
187Extended use of TODO keywords
188
189* Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
dbc28aaa 190* TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
4009494e 191* Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
dbc28aaa
CD
192* Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
193* Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
194* Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
ec712abb 195* TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
dbc28aaa 196
a7808fba 197Progress logging
dbc28aaa
CD
198
199* Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
200* Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
a351880d 201* Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
4009494e
GM
202
203Tags
204
205* Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
206* Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
207* Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
208
209Properties and Columns
210
211* Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
a7808fba 212* Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
4009494e 213* Property searches:: Matching property values
dbc28aaa 214* Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
4009494e
GM
215* Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
216* Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
217
a7808fba 218Column view
4009494e
GM
219
220* Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
221* Using column view:: How to create and use column view
a7808fba 222* Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
4009494e 223
a7808fba 224Defining columns
4009494e
GM
225
226* Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
227* Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
228
dbc28aaa 229Dates and Times
4009494e 230
a7808fba 231* Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
4009494e
GM
232* Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
233* Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
a7808fba 234* Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
a351880d 235* Resolving idle time:: Resolving time if you've been idle
a7808fba 236* Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
96c8522a 237* Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
4009494e
GM
238
239Creating timestamps
240
a7808fba
CD
241* The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
242* Custom time format:: Making dates look different
4009494e 243
a7808fba 244Deadlines and scheduling
4009494e
GM
245
246* Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
247* Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
248
a351880d 249Capture - Refile - Archive
864c9740
CD
250
251* Remember:: Capture new tasks/ideas with little interruption
252* Attachments:: Add files to tasks.
c8d0cf5c 253* RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
a351880d
CD
254* Protocols:: External (e.g. Browser) access to Emacs and Org
255* Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
256* Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
864c9740 257
dbc28aaa 258Remember
4009494e 259
7006d207 260* Setting up Remember for Org:: Some code for .emacs to get things going
dbc28aaa
CD
261* Remember templates:: Define the outline of different note types
262* Storing notes:: Directly get the note to where it belongs
a351880d
CD
263
264Archiving
265
266* Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
267* Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep i in the file
4009494e
GM
268
269Agenda Views
270
271* Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
272* Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
273* Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
274* Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
a7808fba 275* Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
4009494e 276* Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
7006d207 277* Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
a7808fba 278* Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
4009494e
GM
279
280The built-in agenda views
281
a7808fba 282* Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
4009494e
GM
283* Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
284* Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
285* Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
a351880d 286* Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
4009494e
GM
287* Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
288
289Presentation and sorting
290
291* Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
292* Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
293* Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
294
295Custom agenda views
296
297* Storing searches:: Type once, use often
298* Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
299* Setting Options:: Changing the rules
4009494e 300
a351880d
CD
301Markup for rich export
302
303* Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
304* Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
305* Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
306* Include files:: Include additional files into a document
307* Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
308* Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
309
310Structural markup elements
311
312* Document title:: Where the title is taken from
313* Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
314* Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
315* Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
316* Lists:: Lists
317* Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
318* Footnote markup:: Footnotes
319* Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
320* Horizontal rules:: Make a line
321* Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
322
c8d0cf5c 323Embedded La@TeX{}
4009494e 324
a351880d 325* Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
a7808fba 326* Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
4009494e 327* LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
a351880d 328* Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
4009494e
GM
329* CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
330
331Exporting
332
864c9740 333* Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
b349f79f
CD
334* Export options:: Per-file export settings
335* The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
4009494e
GM
336* ASCII export:: Exporting to plain ASCII
337* HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
c8d0cf5c
CD
338* LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to La@TeX{}, and processing to PDF
339* DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
a351880d 340* Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
4009494e
GM
341* XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
342* iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
b349f79f 343
4009494e
GM
344HTML export
345
b349f79f 346* HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
a7808fba 347* Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
a351880d 348* Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
c8d0cf5c 349* Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
55e0839d
CD
350* Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
351* Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
a7808fba
CD
352* CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
353* Javascript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
4009494e 354
c8d0cf5c 355La@TeX{} and PDF export
4009494e 356
a50253cc 357* LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
c8d0cf5c
CD
358* Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal La@TeX{} code
359* Sectioning structure:: Changing sectioning in La@TeX{} output
360* Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to La@TeX{}
361* Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into La@TeX{} output
362
363DocBook export
364
365* DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
366* Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
367* Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
368* Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
369* Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
370* Special characters:: How to handle special characters
4009494e 371
4009494e
GM
372Publishing
373
374* Configuration:: Defining projects
c8d0cf5c 375* Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
4009494e
GM
376* Sample configuration:: Example projects
377* Triggering publication:: Publication commands
378
379Configuration
380
381* Project alist:: The central configuration variable
382* Sources and destinations:: From here to there
383* Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
384* Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
385* Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
386* Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
387* Project page index:: Publishing a list of project files
388
389Sample configuration
390
391* Simple example:: One-component publishing
392* Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
393
394Miscellaneous
395
396* Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
17673adf 397* Speed keys:: Electic commands at the beginning of a headline
a7808fba 398* Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
4009494e
GM
399* In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
400* The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
401* Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
a7808fba 402* TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
4009494e 403* Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
4009494e
GM
404
405Interaction with other packages
406
a7808fba 407* Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
4009494e
GM
408* Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
409
b349f79f 410Hacking
4009494e 411
c8d0cf5c
CD
412* Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
413* Add-on packages:: Available extensions
4009494e 414* Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
c8d0cf5c
CD
415* Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
416* Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for La@TeX{} and other programs
4009494e
GM
417* Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
418* Special agenda views:: Customized views
c8d0cf5c 419* Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
4009494e 420* Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
b349f79f 421* Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
4009494e 422
a7808fba 423Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
4009494e 424
6eb02347 425* Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
4009494e
GM
426* A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
427* Translator functions:: Copy and modify
a7808fba 428* Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
4009494e 429
7006d207
CD
430MobileOrg
431
432* Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
433* Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
434* Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
435
4009494e
GM
436@end detailmenu
437@end menu
438
a7808fba 439@node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
4009494e
GM
440@chapter Introduction
441@cindex introduction
442
443@menu
a7808fba
CD
444* Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
445* Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
446* Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
4009494e 447* Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
dbc28aaa 448* Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
4009494e
GM
449@end menu
450
451@node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
452@section Summary
453@cindex summary
454
a7808fba 455Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
4009494e
GM
456project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
457
a7808fba
CD
458Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
459lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
460implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
4009494e
GM
461content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
462structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
a7808fba 463with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
c8d0cf5c 464timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
4009494e
GM
465agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
466and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
467Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
a7808fba 468For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
dbc28aaa 469structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
4009494e 470iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
a7808fba 471linked web pages.
4009494e 472
c8d0cf5c
CD
473An important design aspect that distinguishes Org from, for example,
474Planner/Muse is that it encourages you to store every piece of information
4009494e 475only once. In Planner, you have project pages, day pages and possibly
a7808fba 476other files, duplicating some information such as tasks. In Org,
c8d0cf5c
CD
477you only have notes files. In your notes you mark entries as tasks, and
478label them with tags and timestamps. All necessary lists, like a
4009494e 479schedule for the day, the agenda for a meeting, tasks lists selected by
c8d0cf5c 480tags, etc., are created dynamically when you need them.
4009494e 481
a7808fba 482Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
4009494e
GM
483feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
484imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
a7808fba 485it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways, for
4009494e
GM
486example as:
487
488@example
c8d0cf5c
CD
489@r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
490@r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
491@r{@bullet{} an ASCII table editor with spreadsheet-like capabilities}
492@r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
493@r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
494@pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
495@r{@bullet{} an environment to implement David Allen's GTD system}
4009494e 496@r{@bullet{} a basic database application}
c8d0cf5c
CD
497@r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and La@TeX{} export}
498@r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
4009494e
GM
499@end example
500
c8d0cf5c 501Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
4009494e 502capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
a7808fba 503minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
4009494e 504tables in arbitrary file types, for example in La@TeX{}. The structure
a7808fba
CD
505editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
506the minor Orgstruct mode.
4009494e
GM
507
508@cindex FAQ
a7808fba
CD
509There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
510version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
c8d0cf5c 511questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc@. This page is located at
dbc28aaa 512@uref{http://orgmode.org}.
4009494e
GM
513
514@page
515
516
517@node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
518@section Installation
519@cindex installation
520@cindex XEmacs
521
7006d207
CD
522@b{Important:} @i{If you are using a version of Org that is part of the Emacs
523distribution or an XEmacs package, please skip this section and go directly
524to @ref{Activation}.}
4009494e 525
a7808fba 526If you have downloaded Org from the Web, either as a distribution @file{.zip}
c8d0cf5c
CD
527or @file{.tar} file, or as a Git archive, you must take the following steps
528to install it: go into the unpacked Org distribution directory and edit the
a7808fba
CD
529top section of the file @file{Makefile}. You must set the name of the Emacs
530binary (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths to the
531directories where local Lisp and Info files are kept. If you don't have
532access to the system-wide directories, you can simply run Org directly from
533the distribution directory by adding the @file{lisp} subdirectory to the
534Emacs load path. To do this, add the following line to @file{.emacs}:
4009494e
GM
535
536@example
a7808fba
CD
537(setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp" load-path))
538@end example
539
540@noindent
541If you plan to use code from the @file{contrib} subdirectory, do a similar
542step for this directory:
543
544@example
545(setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" load-path))
4009494e
GM
546@end example
547
7006d207
CD
548@sp 2
549@cartouche
550XEmacs users now need to install the file @file{noutline.el} from
a7808fba 551the @file{xemacs} sub-directory of the Org distribution. Use the
7006d207 552command:
4009494e
GM
553
554@example
7006d207 555 make install-noutline
4009494e 556@end example
7006d207
CD
557@end cartouche
558@sp 2
4009494e 559
a7808fba 560@noindent Now byte-compile the Lisp files with the shell command:
4009494e
GM
561
562@example
563make
4009494e
GM
564@end example
565
a7808fba 566@noindent If you are running Org from the distribution directory, this is
c8d0cf5c
CD
567all. If you want to install Org into the system directories, use (as
568administrator)
4009494e
GM
569
570@example
a7808fba 571make install
c8d0cf5c
CD
572@end example
573
574Installing Info files is system dependent, because of differences in the
575@file{install-info} program. In Debian it copies the info files into the
576correct directory and modifies the info directory file. In many other
577systems, the files need to be copied to the correct directory separately, and
578@file{install-info} then only modifies the directory file. Check your system
579documentation to find out which of the following commands you need:
580
581@example
4009494e 582make install-info
c8d0cf5c 583make install-info-debian
4009494e
GM
584@end example
585
7006d207
CD
586Then add the following line to @file{.emacs}. It is needed so that
587Emacs can autoload functions that are located in files not immediately loaded
588when Org-mode starts.
4009494e 589@lisp
4009494e
GM
590(require 'org-install)
591@end lisp
592
55e0839d 593Do not forget to activate Org as described in the following section.
7006d207 594@page
a7808fba 595
4009494e
GM
596@node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
597@section Activation
598@cindex activation
599@cindex autoload
a7808fba
CD
600@cindex global key bindings
601@cindex key bindings, global
4009494e
GM
602
603@iftex
c8d0cf5c
CD
604@b{Important:} @i{If you use copy-and-paste to copy Lisp code from the
605PDF documentation as viewed by some PDF viewers to your @file{.emacs} file, the
606single-quote character comes out incorrectly and the code will not work.
607You need to fix the single-quotes by hand, or copy from Info
4009494e
GM
608documentation.}
609@end iftex
610
71d35b24 611Add the following lines to your @file{.emacs} file. The last three lines
a7808fba 612define @emph{global} keys for the commands @command{org-store-link},
c8d0cf5c 613@command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb}---please choose suitable
a7808fba 614keys yourself.
4009494e
GM
615
616@lisp
617;; The following lines are always needed. Choose your own keys.
618(add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
619(global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
620(global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
a7808fba 621(global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
4009494e
GM
622@end lisp
623
a7808fba 624Furthermore, you must activate @code{font-lock-mode} in Org
4009494e
GM
625buffers, because significant functionality depends on font-locking being
626active. You can do this with either one of the following two lines
c8d0cf5c 627(XEmacs users must use the second option):
4009494e
GM
628@lisp
629(global-font-lock-mode 1) ; for all buffers
a7808fba 630(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock) ; Org buffers only
4009494e
GM
631@end lisp
632
a7808fba 633@cindex Org mode, turning on
4009494e 634With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
a7808fba 635into Org mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
4009494e
GM
636like this:
637
638@example
639MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
640@end example
641
c8d0cf5c 642@vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
a7808fba 643@noindent which will select Org mode for this buffer no matter what
4009494e
GM
644the file's name is. See also the variable
645@code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
646
c8d0cf5c
CD
647Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
648use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
649(@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
650in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
b6cb4cd5
CD
651@lisp
652(transient-mark-mode 1)
653@end lisp
c8d0cf5c
CD
654@noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
655active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
656@kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
b6cb4cd5 657
dbc28aaa 658@node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
4009494e
GM
659@section Feedback
660@cindex feedback
661@cindex bug reports
662@cindex maintainer
663@cindex author
664
b349f79f 665If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
c8d0cf5c 666about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
6eb02347
CD
667If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
668list after a moderator has approved it.
4009494e 669
6eb02347
CD
670For bug reports, please provide as much information as possible, including
671the version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
672(@kbd{M-x org-version @key{RET}}), as well as the Org related setup in
673@file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
674@example
675@kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report}
676@end example
677@noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
678that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
679from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
680
681If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
682create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
683about:
4009494e
GM
684
685@enumerate
686@item What exactly did you do?
687@item What did you expect to happen?
688@item What happened instead?
689@end enumerate
690@noindent Thank you for helping to improve this mode.
691
692@subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
693
694@cindex backtrace of an error
a7808fba 695If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
4009494e 696understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
c8d0cf5c 697providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
4009494e
GM
698This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
699error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
700
701@enumerate
702@item
c8d0cf5c
CD
703Reload uncompiled versions of all Org-mode Lisp files. The backtrace
704contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
705To do this, use
4009494e 706@example
c8d0cf5c 707C-u M-x org-reload RET
4009494e 708@end example
c8d0cf5c
CD
709@noindent
710or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
711menu.
4009494e
GM
712@item
713Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
714(XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
715@item
716Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
717document the steps you take.
718@item
719When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
720screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
721attach it to your bug report.
722@end enumerate
723
dbc28aaa
CD
724@node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
725@section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
726
a7808fba 727Org uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags, and property
dbc28aaa
CD
728names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
729
730@table @code
731@item TODO
732@itemx WAITING
733TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
734user-defined.
735@item boss
736@itemx ARCHIVE
737User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
738meaning are written with all capitals.
739@item Release
740@itemx PRIORITY
741User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
742special meaning are written with all capitals.
743@end table
744
a7808fba 745@node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
4009494e
GM
746@chapter Document Structure
747@cindex document structure
748@cindex structure of document
749
c8d0cf5c 750Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
4009494e
GM
751edit the structure of the document.
752
753@menu
a7808fba
CD
754* Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
755* Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
4009494e
GM
756* Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
757* Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
758* Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
4009494e
GM
759* Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
760* Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
761* Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
c8d0cf5c 762* Blocks:: Folding blocks
55e0839d 763* Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
a7808fba 764* Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
4009494e
GM
765@end menu
766
a7808fba 767@node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
4009494e
GM
768@section Outlines
769@cindex outlines
a7808fba 770@cindex Outline mode
4009494e 771
a7808fba 772Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
4009494e
GM
773document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
774for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
775of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
776document to show only the general document structure and the parts
a7808fba 777currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
4009494e 778outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
c8d0cf5c 779command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
4009494e 780
a7808fba 781@node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
4009494e
GM
782@section Headlines
783@cindex headlines
784@cindex outline tree
c8d0cf5c 785@vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
4009494e
GM
786
787Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in
a7808fba 788Org start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See
4009494e
GM
789the variable @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e} to configure special behavior
790of @kbd{C-a} and @kbd{C-e} in headlines.}. For example:
791
792@example
793* Top level headline
794** Second level
795*** 3rd level
796 some text
797*** 3rd level
798 more text
799
800* Another top level headline
801@end example
802
803@noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
804outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
c8d0cf5c 805starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
4009494e 806
c8d0cf5c 807@vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
4009494e
GM
808An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
809will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
810least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
811the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
812variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
813
a7808fba 814@node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
4009494e
GM
815@section Visibility cycling
816@cindex cycling, visibility
817@cindex visibility cycling
818@cindex trees, visibility
819@cindex show hidden text
820@cindex hide text
821
822Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
a7808fba 823Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
4009494e
GM
824@kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
825
826@cindex subtree visibility states
827@cindex subtree cycling
828@cindex folded, subtree visibility state
829@cindex children, subtree visibility state
830@cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
831@table @kbd
832@kindex @key{TAB}
833@item @key{TAB}
834@emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
835
836@example
837,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
838'-----------------------------------'
839@end example
840
c8d0cf5c
CD
841@vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
842@vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
4009494e
GM
843The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
844the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
845beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
846@key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
847option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
848argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
849
850@cindex global visibility states
851@cindex global cycling
852@cindex overview, global visibility state
853@cindex contents, global visibility state
854@cindex show all, global visibility state
855@kindex S-@key{TAB}
856@item S-@key{TAB}
857@itemx C-u @key{TAB}
858@emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
859
860@example
861,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
862'--------------------------------------'
863@end example
864
a7808fba
CD
865When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
866CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
867tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
4009494e
GM
868
869@cindex show all, command
864c9740
CD
870@kindex C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB}
871@item C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB}
872Show all, including drawers.
4009494e
GM
873@kindex C-c C-r
874@item C-c C-r
a7808fba
CD
875Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
876and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
877exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
878(@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
4009494e
GM
879level, all sibling headings.
880@kindex C-c C-x b
881@item C-c C-x b
882Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
883buffer
884@ifinfo
885(@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
886@end ifinfo
887@ifnotinfo
888(see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
889@end ifnotinfo
890will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
891tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
a7808fba
CD
892but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
893prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
894negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
4009494e
GM
895the previously used indirect buffer.
896@end table
897
c8d0cf5c
CD
898@vindex org-startup-folded
899@cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
900@cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
901@cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
7006d207 902@cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
c8d0cf5c 903
a7808fba 904When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
a351880d 905OVERVIEW, i.e. only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
4009494e
GM
906configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
907per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
908buffer:
909
910@example
911#+STARTUP: overview
912#+STARTUP: content
913#+STARTUP: showall
7006d207 914#+STARTUP: showeverything
4009494e
GM
915@end example
916
c8d0cf5c 917@cindex property, VISIBILITY
b349f79f 918@noindent
a50253cc 919Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
b349f79f
CD
920and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
921for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
922@code{all}.
923@table @kbd
924@kindex C-u C-u @key{TAB}
925@item C-u C-u @key{TAB}
a351880d 926Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e. whatever is
b349f79f
CD
927requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
928entries.
929@end table
930
a7808fba 931@node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
4009494e
GM
932@section Motion
933@cindex motion, between headlines
934@cindex jumping, to headlines
935@cindex headline navigation
936The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
937
938@table @kbd
939@kindex C-c C-n
940@item C-c C-n
941Next heading.
942@kindex C-c C-p
943@item C-c C-p
944Previous heading.
945@kindex C-c C-f
946@item C-c C-f
947Next heading same level.
948@kindex C-c C-b
949@item C-c C-b
950Previous heading same level.
951@kindex C-c C-u
952@item C-c C-u
953Backward to higher level heading.
954@kindex C-c C-j
955@item C-c C-j
956Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
957visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
958you can use the following keys to find your destination:
c8d0cf5c 959@vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
4009494e
GM
960@example
961@key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
962@key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
71d35b24
CD
963@key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
964@kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
965@r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
4009494e
GM
966n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
967f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
968u @r{One level up.}
9690-9 @r{Digit argument.}
71d35b24 970q @r{Quit}
4009494e 971@end example
c8d0cf5c
CD
972@vindex org-goto-interface
973@noindent
974See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}.
4009494e
GM
975@end table
976
a351880d 977@node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
4009494e
GM
978@section Structure editing
979@cindex structure editing
980@cindex headline, promotion and demotion
981@cindex promotion, of subtrees
982@cindex demotion, of subtrees
983@cindex subtree, cut and paste
984@cindex pasting, of subtrees
985@cindex cutting, of subtrees
986@cindex copying, of subtrees
6eb02347 987@cindex sorting, of subtrees
4009494e
GM
988@cindex subtrees, cut and paste
989
990@table @kbd
991@kindex M-@key{RET}
992@item M-@key{RET}
c8d0cf5c 993@vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
4009494e
GM
994Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a
995plain list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force
a7808fba 996creation of a new headline, use a prefix argument, or first press @key{RET}
4009494e
GM
997to get to the beginning of the next line. When this command is used in
998the middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes
28a16a1b
CD
999the new headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split,
1000customize the variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the
1001command is used at the beginning of a headline, the new headline is
1002created before the current line. If at the beginning of any other line,
1003the content of that line is made the new heading. If the command is
a351880d 1004used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e. behind the ellipses at the end
28a16a1b
CD
1005of a headline), then a headline like the current one will be inserted
1006after the end of the subtree.
dbc28aaa
CD
1007@kindex C-@key{RET}
1008@item C-@key{RET}
71d35b24
CD
1009Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
1010current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
1011it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
4009494e
GM
1012@kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1013@item M-S-@key{RET}
c8d0cf5c
CD
1014@vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
1015Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
1016variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
864c9740
CD
1017@kindex C-S-@key{RET}
1018@item C-S-@key{RET}
1019Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
1020@kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
1021subtree.
a351880d
CD
1022@kindex @key{TAB}
1023@item @key{TAB} @r{in new, empty entry}
1024In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
1025become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1026and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
1027to the initial level.
4009494e
GM
1028@kindex M-@key{left}
1029@item M-@key{left}
1030Promote current heading by one level.
1031@kindex M-@key{right}
1032@item M-@key{right}
1033Demote current heading by one level.
1034@kindex M-S-@key{left}
1035@item M-S-@key{left}
1036Promote the current subtree by one level.
1037@kindex M-S-@key{right}
1038@item M-S-@key{right}
1039Demote the current subtree by one level.
1040@kindex M-S-@key{up}
1041@item M-S-@key{up}
1042Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
1043level).
1044@kindex M-S-@key{down}
1045@item M-S-@key{down}
1046Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
1047@kindex C-c C-x C-w
4009494e 1048@item C-c C-x C-w
a351880d 1049Kill subtree, i.e. remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
a7808fba 1050With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
4009494e
GM
1051@kindex C-c C-x M-w
1052@item C-c C-x M-w
a7808fba
CD
1053Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
1054sequential subtrees.
4009494e
GM
1055@kindex C-c C-x C-y
1056@item C-c C-x C-y
1057Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
a7808fba
CD
1058make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
1059also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
4009494e 1060headline marker like @samp{****}.
96c8522a 1061@kindex C-y
e45e3595 1062@item C-y
c8d0cf5c
CD
1063@vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
1064@vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
e45e3595
CD
1065Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
1066@code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
1067paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
55033558
CD
1068C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
1069but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
1070previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
1071@code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
1072force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
1073yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
1074folding.
c8d0cf5c
CD
1075@kindex C-c C-x c
1076@item C-c C-x c
1077Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
1078prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
1079timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
1080to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
1081more details, see the docstring of the command
1082@code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
dbc28aaa
CD
1083@kindex C-c C-w
1084@item C-c C-w
e45e3595 1085Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
4009494e
GM
1086@kindex C-c ^
1087@item C-c ^
a7808fba
CD
1088Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
1089region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
1090sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
c8d0cf5c
CD
1091alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
1092creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
1093(in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
1094of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
1095your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
1096sorting will be case-sensitive. With two @kbd{C-u C-u} prefixes, duplicate
1097entries will also be removed.
b349f79f
CD
1098@kindex C-x n s
1099@item C-x n s
1100Narrow buffer to current subtree.
1101@kindex C-x n w
1102@item C-x n w
c8d0cf5c 1103Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
28a16a1b
CD
1104@kindex C-c *
1105@item C-c *
55e0839d
CD
1106Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1107subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1108removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1109region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1110only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
28a16a1b 1111headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
4009494e
GM
1112@end table
1113
1114@cindex region, active
1115@cindex active region
c8d0cf5c
CD
1116@cindex transient mark mode
1117When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
4009494e
GM
1118demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1119headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1120line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1121just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1122inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1123functionality.
1124
28a16a1b 1125
a351880d 1126@node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
4009494e
GM
1127@section Sparse trees
1128@cindex sparse trees
1129@cindex trees, sparse
1130@cindex folding, sparse trees
1131@cindex occur, command
1132
c8d0cf5c
CD
1133@vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
1134@vindex org-show-following-heading
1135@vindex org-show-siblings
1136@vindex org-show-entry-below
b349f79f
CD
1137An important feature of Org mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1138trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1139document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1140visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1141variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1142@code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1143control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1144and you will see immediately how it works.
dbc28aaa 1145
a7808fba 1146Org mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
dbc28aaa 1147commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
4009494e
GM
1148
1149@table @kbd
1150@kindex C-c /
1151@item C-c /
dbc28aaa
CD
1152This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1153@kindex C-c / r
1154@item C-c / r
c8d0cf5c 1155@vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
b349f79f
CD
1156Occur. Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1157the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1158the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1159provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1160is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1161highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
c8d0cf5c 1162editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
b349f79f
CD
1163@code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1164When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1165so several calls to this command can be stacked.
4009494e 1166@end table
dbc28aaa 1167
4009494e 1168@noindent
c8d0cf5c 1169@vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
4009494e
GM
1170For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1171use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1172keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1173accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1174For example:
1175
1176@lisp
1177(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1178 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1179@end lisp
1180
1181@noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1182a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1183
dbc28aaa
CD
1184The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1185tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
4009494e
GM
1186
1187@kindex C-c C-e v
1188@cindex printing sparse trees
1189@cindex visible text, printing
1190To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1191@code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1192of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1193XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1194Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
1195part of the document and print the resulting file.
1196
a7808fba 1197@node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
4009494e
GM
1198@section Plain lists
1199@cindex plain lists
1200@cindex lists, plain
1201@cindex lists, ordered
1202@cindex ordered lists
1203
1204Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1205additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of
a7808fba 1206checkboxes (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists,
dbc28aaa 1207and the HTML exporter (@pxref{Exporting}) parses and formats them.
4009494e 1208
b349f79f
CD
1209Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1210@itemize @bullet
1211@item
1212@emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1213@samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1214they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1215stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star are
1216visually indistinguishable from true headlines. In short: even though
1217@samp{*} is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.}
1218as bullets.
1219@item
1220@emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1221a right parenthesis, such as @samp{1.} or @samp{1)}.
1222@item
a351880d 1223@emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
b349f79f 1224separator @samp{ :: } to separate the description @emph{term} from the
a50253cc 1225description.
b349f79f
CD
1226@end itemize
1227
c8d0cf5c 1228@vindex org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
b349f79f
CD
1229Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1230line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
12312--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1232list. Indentation also determines the end of a list item. It ends before
1233the next line that is indented like the bullet/number, or less. Empty lines
1234are part of the previous item, so you can have several paragraphs in one
1235item. If you would like an empty line to terminate all currently open plain
1236lists, configure the variable @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.
1237Here is an example:
4009494e
GM
1238
1239@example
1240@group
1241** Lord of the Rings
1242 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1243 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
a50253cc 1244 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
4009494e
GM
1245 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1246 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1247 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1248 - on DVD only
1249 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
a50253cc 1250 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
b349f79f 1251 Important actors in this film are:
a50253cc 1252 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
ac20fddf 1253 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
c8d0cf5c 1254 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
4009494e
GM
1255@end group
1256@end example
1257
c8d0cf5c
CD
1258Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
1259them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
1260XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
1261put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
1262properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
1263structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
1264blocks can be indented to signal that they should be part of a list item.
4009494e
GM
1265
1266The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line
1267of an item (the line with the bullet or number).
1268
1269@table @kbd
1270@kindex @key{TAB}
1271@item @key{TAB}
c8d0cf5c
CD
1272@vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
1273Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
1274the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
1275@code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. to @code{integrate}, plain list items
1276will be treated like low-level. The level of an item is then given by the
1277indentation of the bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real
1278headlines, however; the hierarchies remain completely separated.
4009494e
GM
1279
1280If @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists} has not been set, @key{TAB}
a7808fba 1281fixes the indentation of the current line in a heuristic way.
4009494e
GM
1282@kindex M-@key{RET}
1283@item M-@key{RET}
c8d0cf5c 1284@vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
a7808fba
CD
1285Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1286heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1287of a line, the line is @emph{split} and the rest of the line becomes the new
1288item@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the variable
1289@code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed in the
1290@emph{whitespace before a bullet or number}, the new item is created
1291@emph{before} the current item. If the command is executed in the white
1292space before the text that is part of an item but does not contain the
1293bullet, a bullet is added to the current line.
4009494e
GM
1294@kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1295@item M-S-@key{RET}
1296Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
a351880d
CD
1297@kindex @key{TAB}
1298@item @key{TAB} @r{in new, empty item}
1299In a new item with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the item to
1300become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1301and so on, all the way to the left margin. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you
1302are back to the initial level.
4009494e
GM
1303@kindex S-@key{up}
1304@kindex S-@key{down}
1305@item S-@key{up}
1306@itemx S-@key{down}
3da3282e 1307@cindex shift-selection-mode
c8d0cf5c 1308@vindex org-support-shift-select
3da3282e
CD
1309Jump to the previous/next item in the current list, but only if
1310@code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1311jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1312similar effect.
4009494e
GM
1313@kindex M-S-@key{up}
1314@kindex M-S-@key{down}
1315@item M-S-@key{up}
1316@itemx M-S-@key{down}
1317Move the item including subitems up/down (swap with previous/next item
1318of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering is
1319automatic.
1320@kindex M-S-@key{left}
1321@kindex M-S-@key{right}
1322@item M-S-@key{left}
1323@itemx M-S-@key{right}
1324Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1325Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation.
1326When these commands are executed several times in direct succession,
1327the initially selected region is used, even if the new indentation
1328would imply a different hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break
1329the command chain with a cursor motion or so.
1330@kindex C-c C-c
1331@item C-c C-c
1332If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
dbc28aaa
CD
1333state of the checkbox. If not, this command makes sure that all the
1334items on this list level use the same bullet. Furthermore, if this is
a7808fba 1335an ordered list, make sure the numbering is OK.
4009494e
GM
1336@kindex C-c -
1337@item C-c -
a7808fba
CD
1338Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1339(@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}). With a numeric prefix
1340argument N, select the Nth bullet from this list. If there is an active
1341region when calling this, all lines will be converted to list items. If the
1342first line already was a list item, any item markers will be removed from the
1343list. Finally, even without an active region, a normal line will be
1344converted into a list item.
c8d0cf5c
CD
1345@kindex C-c *
1346@item C-c *
1347Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
1348its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
64fb801f
CD
1349@kindex S-@key{left}
1350@kindex S-@key{right}
1351@item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
c8d0cf5c 1352@vindex org-support-shift-select
3da3282e
CD
1353This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1354anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1355@code{org-support-shift-select}.
c8d0cf5c
CD
1356@kindex C-c ^
1357@item C-c ^
1358Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
1359numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
4009494e
GM
1360@end table
1361
c8d0cf5c 1362@node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
4009494e
GM
1363@section Drawers
1364@cindex drawers
c8d0cf5c 1365@cindex #+DRAWERS
4009494e
GM
1366@cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1367
c8d0cf5c 1368@vindex org-drawers
4009494e 1369Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
a7808fba 1370normally don't want to see it. For this, Org mode has @emph{drawers}.
dbc28aaa
CD
1371Drawers need to be configured with the variable
1372@code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define drawers on a per-file basis
1373with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN PROPERTIES STATE}}. Drawers
4009494e
GM
1374look like this:
1375
1376@example
1377** This is a headline
1378 Still outside the drawer
1379 :DRAWERNAME:
1380 This is inside the drawer.
1381 :END:
1382 After the drawer.
1383@end example
1384
c8d0cf5c
CD
1385Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
1386show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
1387look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
1388press @key{TAB} there. Org mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
1389storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
1390for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
1391(@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}.
1392
1393@node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
1394@section Blocks
1395
1396@vindex org-hide-block-startup
1397@cindex blocks, folding
1398Org-mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
1399code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
1400information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
1401unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
1402folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup}
1403or on a per-file basis by using
4009494e 1404
c8d0cf5c
CD
1405@cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1406@cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1407@example
1408#+STARTUP: hideblocks
1409#+STARTUP: nohideblocks
1410@end example
1411
1412@node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
55e0839d
CD
1413@section Footnotes
1414@cindex footnotes
1415
c8d0cf5c
CD
1416Org mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
1417@file{footnote.el} package, Org mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
55e0839d 1418larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
a351880d 1419syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e. a footnote is
55e0839d
CD
1420defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
1421brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
c8d0cf5c 1422inside a footnote, use the La@TeX{} idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
55e0839d
CD
1423is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
1424
1425@example
1426The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1427...
1428[fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1429@end example
1430
c8d0cf5c 1431Org mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
55e0839d
CD
1432optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
1433@file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
c8d0cf5c
CD
1434encouraged because of possible conflicts with La@TeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
1435LaTeX}). Here are the valid references:
55e0839d
CD
1436
1437@table @code
1438@item [1]
c8d0cf5c
CD
1439A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
1440recommended because somthing like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
1441snippet.
55e0839d
CD
1442@item [fn:name]
1443A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1444simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1445@item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
c8d0cf5c 1446A La@TeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
55e0839d
CD
1447reference point.
1448@item [fn:name: a definition]
1449An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
867d4bb3 1450Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
55e0839d
CD
1451@code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1452@end table
1453
c8d0cf5c
CD
1454@vindex org-footnote-auto-label
1455Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
55e0839d
CD
1456This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1457corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords, see the docstring of that variable
1458for details.
1459
1460@noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1461
1462@table @kbd
1463@kindex C-c C-x f
1464@item C-c C-x f
1465The footnote action command.
1466
1467When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1468is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1469
c8d0cf5c
CD
1470@vindex org-footnote-define-inline
1471@vindex org-footnote-section
1472@vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
55e0839d
CD
1473Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
1474@code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1475setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1476definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1477separately into the location determined by the variable
1478@code{org-footnote-section}.
1479
1480When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1481options is offered:
1482@example
1483s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1484 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1485 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
c8d0cf5c
CD
1486 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
1487 @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
1488 @r{variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1489r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
1490 @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable}
1491 @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1492S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
55e0839d
CD
1493n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1494 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1495 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
1496 @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g. sending}
1497 @r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
1498 @r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
1499d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1500 @r{to it.}
1501@end example
c8d0cf5c
CD
1502Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
1503corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
1504renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
1505deletion.
1506
55e0839d
CD
1507@kindex C-c C-c
1508@item C-c C-c
1509If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
1510the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
1511location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
1512@kindex C-c C-o
1513@kindex mouse-1
1514@kindex mouse-2
c8d0cf5c 1515@item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
55e0839d
CD
1516Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
1517you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
1518@end table
1519
1520@node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
4009494e 1521@section The Orgstruct minor mode
a7808fba 1522@cindex Orgstruct mode
4009494e
GM
1523@cindex minor mode for structure editing
1524
a7808fba 1525If you like the intuitive way the Org mode structure editing and list
c8d0cf5c
CD
1526formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
1527Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
1528this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode}, or
1529turn it on by default, for example in Mail mode, with one of:
4009494e
GM
1530
1531@lisp
1532(add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
c8d0cf5c 1533(add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
4009494e
GM
1534@end lisp
1535
c8d0cf5c
CD
1536When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
1537headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
1538will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
1539major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
1540lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadow. When you use
1541@code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and autofill
1542settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an
1543item.
4009494e 1544
a7808fba 1545@node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
4009494e
GM
1546@chapter Tables
1547@cindex tables
1548@cindex editing tables
1549
a7808fba 1550Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
dbc28aaa 1551calculations are supported in connection with the Emacs @file{calc}
28a16a1b 1552package
dbc28aaa 1553@ifinfo
a7808fba 1554(@pxref{Top,Calc,,Calc,Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
dbc28aaa
CD
1555@end ifinfo
1556@ifnotinfo
1557(see the Emacs Calculator manual for more information about the Emacs
1558calculator).
1559@end ifnotinfo
4009494e
GM
1560
1561@menu
1562* Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
c8d0cf5c 1563* Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
4009494e 1564* Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
a7808fba
CD
1565* Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
1566* The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
c8d0cf5c 1567* Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
4009494e
GM
1568@end menu
1569
c8d0cf5c 1570@node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
4009494e
GM
1571@section The built-in table editor
1572@cindex table editor, built-in
1573
a7808fba 1574Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with
4009494e
GM
1575@samp{|} as the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a
1576table. @samp{|} is also the column separator. A table might look like
1577this:
1578
1579@example
1580| Name | Phone | Age |
1581|-------+-------+-----|
1582| Peter | 1234 | 17 |
1583| Anna | 4321 | 25 |
1584@end example
1585
1586A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
1587@key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
1588the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
1589at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
1590of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
1591@samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
1592expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
1593create the above table, you would only type
1594
1595@example
1596|Name|Phone|Age|
1597|-
1598@end example
1599
1600@noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
55e0839d
CD
1601fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
1602@kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
4009494e 1603
c8d0cf5c
CD
1604@vindex org-enable-table-editor
1605@vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
a7808fba 1606When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
4009494e
GM
1607@key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
1608inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
1609typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
1610with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
1611field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
1612unpredictable for you, configure the variables
1613@code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
1614
1615@table @kbd
1616@tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
1617@kindex C-c |
1618@item C-c |
1619Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
1620TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
dbc28aaa 1621If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
4009494e 1622If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
dbc28aaa
CD
1623argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
1624C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
a7808fba 1625consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
28a16a1b 1626@*
a7808fba 1627If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
4009494e
GM
1628table. But it's easier just to start typing, like
1629@kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
1630
1631@tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
1632@kindex C-c C-c
1633@item C-c C-c
1634Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
1635@c
1636@kindex @key{TAB}
1637@item @key{TAB}
1638Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
1639necessary.
1640@c
1641@kindex S-@key{TAB}
1642@item S-@key{TAB}
1643Re-align, move to previous field.
1644@c
1645@kindex @key{RET}
1646@item @key{RET}
1647Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
1648necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
1649NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
c8d0cf5c
CD
1650@c
1651@kindex M-a
1652@item M-a
1653Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
1654@kindex M-e
1655@item M-e
1656Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
4009494e
GM
1657
1658@tsubheading{Column and row editing}
1659@kindex M-@key{left}
1660@kindex M-@key{right}
1661@item M-@key{left}
1662@itemx M-@key{right}
1663Move the current column left/right.
1664@c
1665@kindex M-S-@key{left}
1666@item M-S-@key{left}
1667Kill the current column.
1668@c
1669@kindex M-S-@key{right}
1670@item M-S-@key{right}
1671Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
1672@c
1673@kindex M-@key{up}
1674@kindex M-@key{down}
1675@item M-@key{up}
1676@itemx M-@key{down}
1677Move the current row up/down.
1678@c
1679@kindex M-S-@key{up}
1680@item M-S-@key{up}
1681Kill the current row or horizontal line.
1682@c
1683@kindex M-S-@key{down}
1684@item M-S-@key{down}
a7808fba
CD
1685Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
1686created below the current one.
4009494e
GM
1687@c
1688@kindex C-c -
1689@item C-c -
2096a1b6 1690Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
4009494e
GM
1691is created above the current line.
1692@c
55e0839d
CD
1693@kindex C-c @key{RET}
1694@item C-c @key{RET}
2096a1b6 1695Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
55e0839d
CD
1696below that line.
1697@c
4009494e
GM
1698@kindex C-c ^
1699@item C-c ^
1700Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
1701column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
1702between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
1703point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
1704column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
1705and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
1706included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
1707(alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
1708argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
1709
1710@tsubheading{Regions}
1711@kindex C-c C-x M-w
1712@item C-c C-x M-w
c8d0cf5c
CD
1713Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
1714mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
1715copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
4009494e
GM
1716@c
1717@kindex C-c C-x C-w
1718@item C-c C-x C-w
1719Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
1720blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
1721@c
1722@kindex C-c C-x C-y
1723@item C-c C-x C-y
1724Paste a rectangular region into a table.
864c9740 1725The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
4009494e
GM
1726will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
1727the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
1728lines.
1729@c
28a16a1b 1730@kindex M-@key{RET}
28a16a1b 1731@itemx M-@kbd{RET}
4009494e
GM
1732Wrap several fields in a column like a paragraph. If there is an active
1733region, and both point and mark are in the same column, the text in the
a7808fba
CD
1734column is wrapped to minimum width for the given number of lines. A numeric
1735prefix argument may be used to change the number of desired lines. If there
1736is no region, the current field is split at the cursor position and the text
1737fragment to the right of the cursor is prepended to the field one line
1738down. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument, the current
1739field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field above.
4009494e
GM
1740
1741@tsubheading{Calculations}
1742@cindex formula, in tables
1743@cindex calculations, in tables
1744@cindex region, active
1745@cindex active region
c8d0cf5c 1746@cindex transient mark mode
4009494e
GM
1747@kindex C-c +
1748@item C-c +
1749Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
1750the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
1751be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
1752@c
1753@kindex S-@key{RET}
1754@item S-@key{RET}
c8d0cf5c 1755@vindex org-table-copy-increment
864c9740
CD
1756When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
1757empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
1758Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
1759values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
a50253cc 1760be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
c8d0cf5c
CD
1761increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
1762(@pxref{Conflicts}).
4009494e
GM
1763
1764@tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
1765@kindex C-c `
1766@item C-c `
c8d0cf5c
CD
1767Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
1768are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
1769a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
4009494e
GM
1770edited in place.
1771@c
4009494e 1772@item M-x org-table-import
c8d0cf5c
CD
1773Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
1774separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
dbc28aaa
CD
1775from a database, because these programs generally can write
1776TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
1777the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
1778argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
1779separator.
4009494e 1780@item C-c |
a7808fba 1781Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
4009494e 1782buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
44ce9197 1783@kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
4009494e
GM
1784@c
1785@item M-x org-table-export
c8d0cf5c
CD
1786@vindex org-table-export-default-format
1787Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
a7808fba
CD
1788exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
1789used to export the file can be configured in the variable
1790@code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
1791@code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
b349f79f
CD
1792name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
1793general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
c8d0cf5c 1794format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
b349f79f 1795detailed description.
4009494e
GM
1796@end table
1797
1798If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
1799way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
1800it off with
1801
1802@lisp
1803(setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
1804@end lisp
1805
1806@noindent Then the only table command that still works is
1807@kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
1808
c8d0cf5c
CD
1809@node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
1810@section Column width and alignment
4009494e 1811@cindex narrow columns in tables
c8d0cf5c
CD
1812@cindex alignment in tables
1813
1814The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
1815also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
1816of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
4009494e 1817
4009494e
GM
1818Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text,
1819leading to inconveniently wide columns. To limit@footnote{This feature
1820does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere in
1821the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
1822integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next
1823re-align will then set the width of this column to no more than this
1824value.
1825
1826@example
1827@group
1828|---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
1829| | | | | <6> |
1830| 1 | one | | 1 | one |
1831| 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
1832| 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
1833| 4 | four | | 4 | four |
1834|---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
1835@end group
1836@end example
1837
1838@noindent
1839Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
1840Note that the full text is still in the buffer, it is only invisible.
c8d0cf5c 1841To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
4009494e
GM
1842will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
1843@kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
1844open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
1845C-c}.
1846
c8d0cf5c 1847@vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
4009494e
GM
1848When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
1849necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
1850be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
1851@code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
1852upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
1853on a per-file basis with:
1854
1855@example
1856#+STARTUP: align
1857#+STARTUP: noalign
1858@end example
1859
c8d0cf5c
CD
1860If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
1861to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you and use @samp{<r>} or
1862@samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may also combine alignment and field
1863width like this: @samp{<l10>}.
1864
1865@node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
4009494e
GM
1866@section Column groups
1867@cindex grouping columns in tables
1868
a7808fba 1869When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
4009494e
GM
1870lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
1871however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
1872of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
1873order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
1874first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
1875contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
1876@samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} to make a column
a7808fba 1877a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
4009494e
GM
1878marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
1879
1880@example
1881| | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
1882|---+----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
1883| / | <> | < | | > | < | > |
1884| # | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
1885| # | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
1886| # | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
1887|---+----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
44ce9197 1888#+TBLFM: $3=$2^2::$4=$2^3::$5=$2^4::$6=sqrt($2)::$7=sqrt(sqrt(($2)))
4009494e
GM
1889@end example
1890
a7808fba 1891It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
4009494e
GM
1892every vertical line you'd like to have:
1893
1894@example
1895| N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
1896|----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
1897| / | < | | | < | |
1898@end example
1899
a7808fba 1900@node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
4009494e 1901@section The Orgtbl minor mode
a7808fba 1902@cindex Orgtbl mode
4009494e
GM
1903@cindex minor mode for tables
1904
a7808fba
CD
1905If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
1906might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
1907The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
4009494e
GM
1908the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
1909example in mail mode, use
1910
1911@lisp
1912(add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
1913@end lisp
1914
1915Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
a7808fba 1916in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
4009494e 1917construct La@TeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
a7808fba 1918Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
4009494e
GM
1919@ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
1920
c8d0cf5c 1921@node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
4009494e
GM
1922@section The spreadsheet
1923@cindex calculations, in tables
1924@cindex spreadsheet capabilities
1925@cindex @file{calc} package
1926
1927The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
1928spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
a7808fba 1929derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's
4009494e 1930implementation is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example,
a7808fba 1931Org knows the concept of a @emph{column formula} that will be
4009494e
GM
1932applied to all non-header fields in a column without having to copy the
1933formula to each relevant field.
1934
1935@menu
1936* References:: How to refer to another field or range
1937* Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
1938* Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
1939* Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
1940* Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
1941* Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
1942* Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
1943* Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
1944@end menu
1945
1946@node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
1947@subsection References
1948@cindex references
1949
1950To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
a7808fba 1951reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
4009494e
GM
1952by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
1953out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
1954field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
1955
1956@subsubheading Field references
1957@cindex field references
1958@cindex references, to fields
1959
1960Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
1961any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
1962combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
1963@c Such references are always fixed to that field, they don't change
1964@c when you copy and paste a formula to a different field. So
a7808fba 1965@c Org's @code{B3} behaves like @code{$B$3} in other spreadsheets.
4009494e
GM
1966
1967@noindent
a7808fba 1968Org also uses another, more general operator that looks like this:
4009494e 1969@example
c8d0cf5c 1970@@@var{row}$@var{column}
4009494e
GM
1971@end example
1972
1973@noindent
c8d0cf5c 1974Column references can be absolute like @samp{1}, @samp{2},...@samp{@var{N}},
73ef3bde 1975or relative to the current column like @samp{+1} or @samp{-2}.
4009494e
GM
1976
1977The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal
1978separator lines (hlines). You can use absolute row numbers
c8d0cf5c 1979@samp{1}...@samp{@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the current row like
4009494e 1980@samp{+3} or @samp{-1}. Or specify the row relative to one of the
dbc28aaa
CD
1981hlines: @samp{I} refers to the first hline@footnote{Note that only
1982hlines are counted that @emph{separate} table lines. If the table
1983starts with a hline above the header, it does not count.}, @samp{II} to
c8d0cf5c 1984the second, etc@. @samp{-I} refers to the first such line above the
dbc28aaa
CD
1985current line, @samp{+I} to the first such line below the current line.
1986You can also write @samp{III+2} which is the second data line after the
c8d0cf5c 1987third hline in the table.
4009494e
GM
1988
1989@samp{0} refers to the current row and column. Also, if you omit
1990either the column or the row part of the reference, the current
28a16a1b 1991row/column is implied.
4009494e 1992
a7808fba 1993Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
4009494e
GM
1994in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
1995different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
a7808fba 1996Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
4009494e
GM
1997references because the same reference operator can reference different
1998fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
1999
c8d0cf5c
CD
2000As a special case, references like @samp{$LR5} and @samp{$LR12} can be used
2001to refer in a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the
55e0839d 2002table.
b6cb4cd5 2003
4009494e
GM
2004Here are a few examples:
2005
2006@example
2007@@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column}
2008C2 @r{same as previous}
2009$5 @r{column 5 in the current row}
2010E& @r{same as previous}
2011@@2 @r{current column, row 2}
2012@@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
2013@@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
2014@end example
2015
2016@subsubheading Range references
2017@cindex range references
2018@cindex references, to ranges
2019
2020You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
2021references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
2022current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
2023is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
2024format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
2025@samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
2026
2027@example
2028$1..$3 @r{First three fields in the current row.}
2029$P..$Q @r{Range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
2030@@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields.}
2031A2..C4 @r{Same as above.}
2032@@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row}
2033@end example
2034
2035@noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
2036into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
2037suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
2038see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
2039@samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
2040
2041@subsubheading Named references
2042@cindex named references
2043@cindex references, named
2044@cindex name, of column or field
2045@cindex constants, in calculations
c8d0cf5c 2046@cindex #+CONSTANTS
4009494e 2047
c8d0cf5c 2048@vindex org-table-formula-constants
4009494e
GM
2049@samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
2050constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
2051@code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
2052line like
2053
2054@example
2055#+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
2056@end example
2057
2058@noindent
c8d0cf5c
CD
2059@vindex constants-unit-system
2060@pindex constants.el
a7808fba 2061Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
c8d0cf5c 2062constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
dbc28aaa 2063@samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
4009494e
GM
2064outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
2065@file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
2066including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
c8d0cf5c 2067units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
4009494e
GM
2068supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
2069and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2070@code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
2071@code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
2072buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2073lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
2074names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
2075numbers.
2076
55e0839d
CD
2077@subsubheading Remote references
2078@cindex remote references
2079@cindex references, remote
2080@cindex references, to a different table
2081@cindex name, of column or field
2082@cindex constants, in calculations
c8d0cf5c 2083@cindex #+TBLNAME
55e0839d
CD
2084
2085You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2086either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2087
2088@example
2089remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2090@end example
2091
2092@noindent
2093where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2094@code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2095entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2096table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
c8d0cf5c
CD
2097described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
2098referenced table.
55e0839d 2099
4009494e
GM
2100@node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
2101@subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2102@cindex formula syntax, Calc
2103@cindex syntax, of formulas
2104
2105A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
2106@file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
2107non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
2108@samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
2109evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
a7808fba 2110Your Programs,calc-eval,Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs,Calc,GNU
4009494e 2111Emacs Calc Manual}),
a7808fba 2112@c FIXME: The link to the Calc manual in HTML does not work.
4009494e
GM
2113variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
2114@cindex vectors, in table calculations
a7808fba 2115The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
4009494e
GM
2116like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2117
2118@cindex format specifier
2119@cindex mode, for @file{calc}
c8d0cf5c 2120@vindex org-calc-default-modes
4009494e
GM
2121A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2122string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
a7808fba 2123execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
44ce9197 212412, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
c8d0cf5c 2125format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
4009494e
GM
2126compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
2127@code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2128
2129@example
2130p20 @r{switch the internal precision to 20 digits}
2131n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed display format}
2132D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
2133F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
2134N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
2135T @r{force text interpretation}
2136E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
c8d0cf5c 2137L @r{literal}
4009494e
GM
2138@end example
2139
2140@noindent
2141In addition, you may provide a @code{printf} format specifier to
2142reformat the final result. A few examples:
2143
2144@example
2145$1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2146$1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2147exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2148$0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2149($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2150$c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2151tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2152sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2153vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
2154vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
2155taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2156@end example
2157
2158Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
2159
2160@example
2161if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{``teen'' if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
2162@end example
2163
2164@node Formula syntax for Lisp, Field formulas, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2165@subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2166@cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2167
2168It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp; this can be useful
a50253cc 2169for string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's
c8d0cf5c
CD
2170functionality is not enough. If a formula starts with a single-quote
2171followed by an opening parenthesis, then it is evaluated as a Lisp form.
4009494e
GM
2172The evaluation should return either a string or a number. Just as with
2173@file{calc} formulas, you can specify modes and a printf format after a
a7808fba 2174semicolon. With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way
4009494e 2175field references are interpolated into the form. By default, a
c8d0cf5c 2176reference will be interpolated as a Lisp string (in double-quotes)
4009494e
GM
2177containing the field. If you provide the @samp{N} mode switch, all
2178referenced elements will be numbers (non-number fields will be zero) and
2179interpolated as Lisp numbers, without quotes. If you provide the
2180@samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated literally, without quotes.
a351880d 2181I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted as a string by the Lisp
c8d0cf5c 2182form, enclose the reference operator itself in double-quotes, like
4009494e
GM
2183@code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated fields, so you can
2184embed them in list or vector syntax. A few examples, note how the
c8d0cf5c 2185@samp{N} mode is used when we do computations in Lisp.
4009494e
GM
2186
2187@example
2188@r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
2189 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2096a1b6 2190@r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
4009494e
GM
2191 '(+ $1 $2);N
2192@r{Compute the sum of columns 1-4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
2193 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2194@end example
2195
2196@node Field formulas, Column formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
2197@subsection Field formulas
2198@cindex field formula
2199@cindex formula, for individual table field
2200
2201To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the
2202field, preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=$1+$2}. When you
2203press @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in
2204the field, the formula will be stored as the formula for this field,
2205evaluated, and the current field replaced with the result.
2206
c8d0cf5c 2207@cindex #+TBLFM
4009494e
GM
2208Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:}
2209directly below the table. If you typed the equation in the 4th field of
2210the 3rd data line in the table, the formula will look like
2211@samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows
2212with the appropriate commands, @i{absolute references} (but not relative
2213ones) in stored formulas are modified in order to still reference the
c8d0cf5c
CD
2214same field. Of course this is not true if you edit the table structure
2215with normal editing commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
2216The left-hand side of a formula may also be a named field (@pxref{Advanced
b6cb4cd5 2217features}), or a last-row reference like @samp{$LR3}.
4009494e
GM
2218
2219Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2220following command
2221
2222@table @kbd
2223@kindex C-u C-c =
2224@item C-u C-c =
2225Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
c8d0cf5c
CD
2226formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2227it to the current field, and stores it.
4009494e
GM
2228@end table
2229
2230@node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field formulas, The spreadsheet
2231@subsection Column formulas
2232@cindex column formula
2233@cindex formula, for table column
2234
2235Often in a table, the same formula should be used for all fields in a
2236particular column. Instead of having to copy the formula to all fields
c8d0cf5c 2237in that column, Org allows you to assign a single formula to an entire
4009494e
GM
2238column. If the table contains horizontal separator hlines, everything
2239before the first such line is considered part of the table @emph{header}
2240and will not be modified by column formulas.
2241
2242To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2243column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
c8d0cf5c
CD
2244@key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2245the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
2246and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
2247@samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
2248column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
2249@samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The left-hand
2250side of a column formula cannot currently be the name of column, it
2251must be the numeric column reference.
4009494e
GM
2252
2253Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2254following command:
2255
2256@table @kbd
2257@kindex C-c =
2258@item C-c =
a7808fba
CD
2259Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2260the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2261taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
a351880d 2262stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g. @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
4009494e
GM
2263will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2264@end table
2265
4009494e 2266@node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
a7808fba 2267@subsection Editing and debugging formulas
4009494e
GM
2268@cindex formula editing
2269@cindex editing, of table formulas
2270
c8d0cf5c 2271@vindex org-table-use-standard-references
4009494e 2272You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
a7808fba
CD
2273field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
2274formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
4009494e
GM
2275converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
2276if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
2277@code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
2278@code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2279
2280@table @kbd
2281@kindex C-c =
2282@kindex C-u C-c =
2283@item C-c =
2284@itemx C-u C-c =
2285Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
c8d0cf5c 2286minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field formulas}.
4009494e
GM
2287@kindex C-u C-u C-c =
2288@item C-u C-u C-c =
2289Re-insert the active formula (either a
2290field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2291can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2292minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2293@kindex C-c ?
2294@item C-c ?
2295While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2296referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2297@kindex C-c @}
2298@item C-c @}
2299Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using
c8d0cf5c 2300overlays. These are updated each time the table is aligned; you can
4009494e
GM
2301force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2302@kindex C-c @{
2303@item C-c @{
2304Toggle the formula debugger on and off. See below.
2305@kindex C-c '
2306@item C-c '
2307Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2308formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2309active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
a7808fba 2310While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
4009494e
GM
2311any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2312remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2313@table @kbd
2314@kindex C-c C-c
2315@kindex C-x C-s
2316@item C-c C-c
2317@itemx C-x C-s
2318Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2319prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2320@kindex C-c C-q
2321@item C-c C-q
2322Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2323@kindex C-c C-r
2324@item C-c C-r
2325Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
2326@code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2327@kindex @key{TAB}
2328@item @key{TAB}
c8d0cf5c
CD
2329Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
2330a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
4009494e 2331Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
c8d0cf5c 2332formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
4009494e
GM
2333@kindex M-@key{TAB}
2334@item M-@key{TAB}
c8d0cf5c 2335Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
4009494e
GM
2336@kindex S-@key{up}
2337@kindex S-@key{down}
2338@kindex S-@key{left}
2339@kindex S-@key{right}
2340@item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
2341Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
2342@code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
c8d0cf5c 2343This also works for relative references and for hline references.
4009494e
GM
2344@kindex M-S-@key{up}
2345@kindex M-S-@key{down}
2346@item M-S-@key{up}/@key{down}
a7808fba 2347Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
4009494e
GM
2348down.
2349@kindex M-@key{up}
2350@kindex M-@key{down}
2351@item M-@key{up}/@key{down}
2352Scroll the window displaying the table.
2353@kindex C-c @}
2354@item C-c @}
2355Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2356@end table
2357@end table
2358
2359Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
c8d0cf5c
CD
2360the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
2361line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
4009494e
GM
2362To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
2363prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
2364
2365@kindex C-c C-c
2366You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
c8d0cf5c 2367equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
4009494e
GM
2368recalculation commands in the table.
2369
2370@subsubheading Debugging formulas
2371@cindex formula debugging
2372@cindex debugging, of table formulas
2373When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2374becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
2375on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
2376turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2377calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
2378field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2379
2380@node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
a7808fba 2381@subsection Updating the table
4009494e
GM
2382@cindex recomputing table fields
2383@cindex updating, table
2384
2385Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
c8d0cf5c
CD
2386triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
2387recalculation at least semi-automatic.
4009494e
GM
2388
2389In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
2390following commands:
2391
2392@table @kbd
2393@kindex C-c *
2394@item C-c *
2395Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
2396from left to right, and all field formulas in the current row.
2397@c
2398@kindex C-u C-c *
2399@item C-u C-c *
2400@kindex C-u C-c C-c
2401@itemx C-u C-c C-c
2402Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
2403hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2404@c
2405@kindex C-u C-u C-c *
2406@kindex C-u C-u C-c C-c
2407@item C-u C-u C-c *
2408@itemx C-u C-u C-c C-c
2409Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
2410This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
2411fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
2412@end table
2413
2414@node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2415@subsection Advanced features
2416
2417If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if
2418you want to be able to assign @i{names} to fields and columns, you need
2419to reserve the first column of the table for special marking characters.
2420@table @kbd
2421@kindex C-#
2422@item C-#
a351880d 2423Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
864c9740
CD
2424@samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
2425change all marks in the region.
4009494e
GM
2426@end table
2427
2428Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
2429makes use of these features:
2430
2431@example
2432@group
2433|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2434| | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
2435|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2436| ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
2437| # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
2438| ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
2439|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2440| # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
4009494e
GM
2441| # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
2442|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2443| | Average | | | | 29.7 | |
2444| ^ | | | | | at | |
2445| $ | max=50 | | | | | |
2446|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2447#+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
2448@end group
2449@end example
2450
c8d0cf5c 2451@noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
4009494e
GM
2452recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
2453are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
2454to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
2455empty first field.
2456
2457@cindex marking characters, tables
2458The marking characters have the following meaning:
2459@table @samp
2460@item !
2461The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
2462refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
2463@item ^
2464This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
2465a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
2466the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
2467will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
2468@item _
2469Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
2470@emph{below}.
2471@item $
2472Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
2473example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
2474formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
2475Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
2476a per-table basis.
2477@item #
2478Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
2479@key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
2480is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
2481lines will be left alone by this command.
2482@item *
2483Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
2484not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
2485recalculation slows down editing too much.
2486@item
2487Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
2488All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
2489or @samp{*}.
2490@item /
2491Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
6eb02347 2492@samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
4009494e
GM
2493@end table
2494
c8d0cf5c
CD
2495Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
2496fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
28a16a1b
CD
2497series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
2498functions.
4009494e
GM
2499
2500@example
2501@group
2502|---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2503| | Func | n | x | Result |
2504|---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2505| # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
2506| # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
2507| # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
2508| # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
2509| # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
2510| * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
2511|---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2512#+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
2513@end group
2514@end example
2515
c8d0cf5c
CD
2516@node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
2517@section Org-Plot
864c9740
CD
2518@cindex graph, in tables
2519@cindex plot tables using gnuplot
c8d0cf5c 2520@cindex #+PLOT
864c9740 2521
c8d0cf5c 2522Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
71d35b24
CD
2523using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
2524@uref{http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html}. To see
c8d0cf5c 2525this in action, ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed
71d35b24 2526on your system, then call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
864c9740
CD
2527
2528@example
2529@group
2530#+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
2531| Sede | Max cites | H-index |
2532|-----------+-----------+---------|
2533| Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
2534| Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
2535| Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
2536| Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
2537| Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
2538@end group
2539@end example
2540
c8d0cf5c 2541Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
864c9740 2542Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
c8d0cf5c
CD
2543be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
2544for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
2545see the Org-plot tutorial at
d324fa76 2546@uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.php}.
864c9740
CD
2547
2548@subsubheading Plot Options
2549
2550@table @code
2551@item set
c8d0cf5c 2552Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
864c9740
CD
2553
2554@item title
2555Specify the title of the plot.
2556
2557@item ind
2558Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
2559
2560@item deps
c8d0cf5c 2561Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
71d35b24 2562and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
c8d0cf5c 2563fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
71d35b24 2564column).
864c9740
CD
2565
2566@item type
2567Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
2568
2569@item with
2570Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
a351880d 2571(e.g. @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
223b43fa 2572Defaults to @code{lines}.
864c9740
CD
2573
2574@item file
c8d0cf5c 2575If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
864c9740
CD
2576
2577@item labels
c8d0cf5c
CD
2578List of labels to be used for the deps (defaults to the column headers if
2579they exist).
864c9740
CD
2580
2581@item line
c8d0cf5c 2582Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
864c9740
CD
2583
2584@item map
2585When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
2586flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
2587
e45e3595 2588@item timefmt
c8d0cf5c 2589Specify format of Org-mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
223b43fa 2590Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
e45e3595 2591
864c9740 2592@item script
c8d0cf5c
CD
2593If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
2594between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
864c9740 2595instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
c8d0cf5c 2596the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
864c9740
CD
2597may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
2598the data file.
2599@end table
2600
a7808fba 2601@node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
4009494e
GM
2602@chapter Hyperlinks
2603@cindex hyperlinks
2604
a7808fba 2605Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
dbc28aaa 2606other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
4009494e
GM
2607
2608@menu
a7808fba 2609* Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
4009494e
GM
2610* Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
2611* External links:: URL-like links to the world
2612* Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
a7808fba 2613* Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
4009494e
GM
2614* Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
2615* Search options:: Linking to a specific location
2616* Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
4009494e
GM
2617@end menu
2618
2619@node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
2620@section Link format
2621@cindex link format
2622@cindex format, of links
2623
a7808fba 2624Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
4009494e
GM
2625clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
2626
2627@example
28a16a1b 2628[[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
4009494e
GM
2629@end example
2630
c8d0cf5c 2631@noindent
a7808fba 2632Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
4009494e
GM
2633will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
2634of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
2635@samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
2636which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
2637visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
2638part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
2639edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
2640cursor on the link.
2641
2642If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
2643displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
2644(invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
2645and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
2646missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
2647internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
2648@code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
2649
2650@node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
2651@section Internal links
2652@cindex internal links
2653@cindex links, internal
2654@cindex targets, for links
2655
c8d0cf5c
CD
2656@cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
2657If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
2658current file. The most important case is a link like
2659@samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
2660@code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. Such custom IDs are very good
2661for HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}) where they produce pretty section
2662links. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique
2663in a file.
2664
2665Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
2666lead to a text search in the current file.
2667
2668The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
2669or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
2670point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
2671a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets. Targets
2672may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient to put them into a
2673comment line. For example
4009494e
GM
2674
2675@example
2676# <<My Target>>
2677@end example
2678
2679@noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
64fb801f
CD
2680named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
2681text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
2682target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
2683first headline.}.
4009494e 2684
c8d0cf5c
CD
2685If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for the words in the link. In
2686the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}. Links starting
2687with a star like @samp{*My Target} restrict the search to
2688headlines@footnote{To insert a link targeting a headline, in-buffer
2689completion can be used. Just type a star followed by a few optional letters
2690into the buffer and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current
2691buffer will be offered as completions. @xref{Handling links}, for more
2692commands creating links.}. When searching, Org mode will first try an
2693exact match, but then move on to more and more lenient searches. For
2694example, the link @samp{[[*My Targets]]} will find any of the following:
4009494e
GM
2695
2696@example
2697** My targets
2698** TODO my targets are bright
2699** my 20 targets are
2700@end example
2701
4009494e 2702
a7808fba 2703Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
4009494e
GM
2704return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
2705several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
2706earlier.
2707
2708@menu
a7808fba 2709* Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
4009494e
GM
2710@end menu
2711
2712@node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
2713@subsection Radio targets
2714@cindex radio targets
2715@cindex targets, radio
2716@cindex links, radio targets
2717
a7808fba 2718Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
4009494e
GM
2719in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
2720text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
2721enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
2722Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
a7808fba 2723become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
4009494e
GM
2724for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
2725update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
2726cursor on or at a target.
2727
2728@node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
2729@section External links
2730@cindex links, external
2731@cindex external links
2732@cindex links, external
a7808fba 2733@cindex Gnus links
4009494e 2734@cindex BBDB links
28a16a1b 2735@cindex IRC links
4009494e
GM
2736@cindex URL links
2737@cindex file links
2738@cindex VM links
2739@cindex RMAIL links
2740@cindex WANDERLUST links
2741@cindex MH-E links
2742@cindex USENET links
2743@cindex SHELL links
2744@cindex Info links
c8d0cf5c 2745@cindex Elisp links
4009494e 2746
a7808fba 2747Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
28a16a1b
CD
2748BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
2749logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
2750identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
2751the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
4009494e
GM
2752
2753@example
a7808fba 2754http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
4009494e 2755file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
44ce9197 2756/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
4009494e 2757file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
44ce9197 2758./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
a351880d 2759file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file with line number to jump to}
c8d0cf5c
CD
2760file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
2761file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}
2762file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
55e0839d 2763id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
4009494e 2764news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
55e0839d 2765mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
4009494e
GM
2766vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
2767vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
55e0839d 2768vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
4009494e
GM
2769wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
2770wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
2771mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
2772mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
2773rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
2774rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
a7808fba
CD
2775gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
2776gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
64fb801f 2777bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
28a16a1b 2778irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
4009494e 2779shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
c8d0cf5c 2780elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
64fb801f 2781elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
4009494e
GM
2782@end example
2783
2784A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
a7808fba 2785descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
4009494e
GM
2786format}), for example:
2787
2788@example
2789[[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
2790@end example
2791
2792@noindent
2793If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
2794export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
2795button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
2796image,
2797that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
2798
c8d0cf5c 2799@cindex square brackets, around links
4009494e 2800@cindex plain text external links
a7808fba 2801Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
4009494e
GM
2802as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
2803@samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
c8d0cf5c 2804about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
4009494e 2805
a7808fba 2806@node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
4009494e
GM
2807@section Handling links
2808@cindex links, handling
2809
a7808fba
CD
2810Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
2811insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
4009494e
GM
2812
2813@table @kbd
2814@kindex C-c l
2815@cindex storing links
2816@item C-c l
55e0839d
CD
2817Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
2818must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
2819create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
c8d0cf5c
CD
2820buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
2821buffer:
55e0839d 2822
c8d0cf5c 2823@b{Org-mode buffers}@*
55e0839d 2824For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
c8d0cf5c
CD
2825to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
2826be the description.
2827
2828@vindex org-link-to-org-use-id
2829@cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
2830@cindex property, ID
2831If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
2832will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
2833@code{org-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will be
2834created and/or used to construct a link. So using this command in Org
2835buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom
2836ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from
2837file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
2838to use.
2839
2840@b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
2841Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
2842current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
2843constructed from the author and the subject.
2844
2845@b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
2846Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
2847
2848@b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
2849Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
2850
2851@b{Chat: IRC}@*
2852@vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
2853For IRC links, if you set the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to
2854@code{t}, a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for
2855the current conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to
2856the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
2857
2858@b{Other files}@*
55e0839d
CD
2859For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
2860(@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
2861there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
2862search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
2863accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
c8d0cf5c
CD
2864and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
2865The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
7006d207
CD
2866
2867@b{Agenda view}@*
2868When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
2869entry referenced by the current line.
2870
4009494e
GM
2871@c
2872@kindex C-c C-l
2873@cindex link completion
2874@cindex completion, of links
2875@cindex inserting links
2876@item C-c C-l
c8d0cf5c
CD
2877@vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
2878Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
2879insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
2880straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
2881enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
2882descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
2883You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
2884type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
2885into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
2886removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
2887a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
a7808fba
CD
2888@code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
2889If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
c8d0cf5c
CD
2890becomes the default description.
2891
2892@b{Inserting stored links}@*
2893All links stored during the
2894current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
2895them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
2896
2897@b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
2898valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
2899defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
2900press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
2901specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
2902calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
2903example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
2904access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
2905@key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
4009494e
GM
2906@kindex C-u C-c C-l
2907@cindex file name completion
2908@cindex completion, of file names
2909@item C-u C-c C-l
2910When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
2911a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
2912the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
c8d0cf5c 2913directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
a7808fba 2914directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
4009494e
GM
2915to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
2916is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
2917force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
2918@c
2919@item C-c C-l @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
2920When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
2921link and description parts of the link.
2922@c
2923@cindex following links
2924@kindex C-c C-o
55033558 2925@kindex RET
c8d0cf5c
CD
2926@item C-c C-o @r{or} @key{RET}
2927@vindex org-file-apps
4009494e 2928Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
864c9740
CD
2929@command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
2930the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
2931cursor is on an internal link, this commands runs the corresponding search.
2932When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
c8d0cf5c 2933TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
864c9740
CD
2934date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
2935with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
2936Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
2937@code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
e45e3595 2938visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
6eb02347
CD
2939opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
2940If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
2941headline and entry text.
4009494e
GM
2942@c
2943@kindex mouse-2
2944@kindex mouse-1
2945@item mouse-2
2946@itemx mouse-1
2947On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
c8d0cf5c 2948would. Under Emacs 22, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
4009494e
GM
2949@c
2950@kindex mouse-3
2951@item mouse-3
c8d0cf5c 2952@vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
4009494e
GM
2953Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
2954internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
2955variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
2956@c
2957@cindex mark ring
2958@kindex C-c %
2959@item C-c %
2960Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
2961easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
2962@c
2963@cindex links, returning to
2964@kindex C-c &
2965@item C-c &
2966Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
2967commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
2968command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
2969previously recorded positions.
2970@c
2971@kindex C-c C-x C-n
2972@kindex C-c C-x C-p
2973@cindex links, finding next/previous
2974@item C-c C-x C-n
2975@itemx C-c C-x C-p
2976Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
2977the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
2978bindings for this are really too long, you might want to bind this also
2979to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
2980@lisp
2981(add-hook 'org-load-hook
2982 (lambda ()
2983 (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
2984 (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
2985@end lisp
2986@end table
2987
a7808fba
CD
2988@node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
2989@section Using links outside Org
4009494e 2990
a7808fba
CD
2991You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
2992Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
4009494e
GM
2993global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
2994yourself):
2995
2996@lisp
2997(global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
2998(global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
2999@end lisp
3000
a7808fba 3001@node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
4009494e
GM
3002@section Link abbreviations
3003@cindex link abbreviations
3004@cindex abbreviation, links
3005
3006Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
3007needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
3008abbreviated link looks like this
3009
3010@example
3011[[linkword:tag][description]]
3012@end example
3013
3014@noindent
c8d0cf5c
CD
3015@vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
3016where the tag is optional. The @i{linkword} must be a word; letter, numbers,
3017@samp{-}, and @samp{_} are allowed here. Abbreviations are resolved
3018according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
3019that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
4009494e
GM
3020
3021@lisp
3022@group
3023(setq org-link-abbrev-alist
3024 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
3025 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
3026 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/
3027 nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
3028@end group
3029@end lisp
3030
3031If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
3032replaced with the tag. Otherwise the tag will be appended to the string
3033in order to create the link. You may also specify a function that will
3034be called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
3035
3036With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
3037@code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
a7808fba 3038@code{[[google:OrgMode]]} and find out what the Org author is
4009494e
GM
3039doing besides Emacs hacking with @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
3040
a7808fba 3041If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
4009494e
GM
3042can define them in the file with
3043
c8d0cf5c 3044@cindex #+LINK
4009494e
GM
3045@example
3046#+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
3047#+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
3048@end example
3049
3050@noindent
c8d0cf5c
CD
3051In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
3052complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
a351880d 3053@code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g. completion)
c8d0cf5c
CD
3054support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
3055not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
4009494e
GM
3056
3057@node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
3058@section Search options in file links
3059@cindex search option in file links
3060@cindex file links, searching
3061
3062File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
3063particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
3064line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
3065compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
3066example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
3067links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
3068string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
28a16a1b 3069link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
4009494e
GM
3070
3071Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
3072link, together with an explanation:
3073
3074@example
3075[[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
3076[[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
3077[[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
3078[[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
3079@end example
3080
3081@table @code
3082@item 255
3083Jump to line 255.
3084@item My Target
3085Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
3086@samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
3087@ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
3088link will become an HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
3089the linked file.
3090@item *My Target
a7808fba 3091In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
4009494e
GM
3092@item /regexp/
3093Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
3094command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
a7808fba 3095target file is in Org mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
4009494e
GM
3096sparse tree with the matches.
3097@c If the target file is a directory,
3098@c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
3099@end table
3100
3101As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
3102to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
3103a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
3104@samp{[[find me]]} would.
3105
dbc28aaa 3106@node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
4009494e
GM
3107@section Custom Searches
3108@cindex custom search strings
3109@cindex search strings, custom
3110
3111The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
3112actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
c8d0cf5c 3113cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
4009494e 3114@samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
c8d0cf5c 3115because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
4009494e
GM
3116citation key.
3117
c8d0cf5c
CD
3118@vindex org-create-file-search-functions
3119@vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
4009494e
GM
3120If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
3121the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
3122for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
3123to be added to the hook variables
3124@code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
3125@code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
a7808fba 3126variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
4009494e 3127for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
44ce9197 3128an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
4009494e 3129
a7808fba
CD
3130@node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
3131@chapter TODO Items
4009494e
GM
3132@cindex TODO items
3133
44ce9197 3134Org mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
a50253cc 3135course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
44ce9197
CD
3136but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
3137notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
3138mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
3139information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
3140item emerged is always present.
4009494e 3141
dbc28aaa 3142Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
a7808fba 3143throughout your notes file. Org mode compensates for this by providing
dbc28aaa 3144methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
4009494e
GM
3145
3146@menu
3147* TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3148* TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
dbc28aaa 3149* Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
4009494e
GM
3150* Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
3151* Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
3152* Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
3153@end menu
3154
a7808fba 3155@node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
4009494e
GM
3156@section Basic TODO functionality
3157
dbc28aaa
CD
3158Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
3159@samp{TODO}, for example:
4009494e
GM
3160
3161@example
3162*** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
3163@end example
3164
3165@noindent
3166The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
3167
3168@table @kbd
3169@kindex C-c C-t
3170@cindex cycling, of TODO states
3171@item C-c C-t
3172Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
3173
3174@example
3175,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
3176'--------------------------------'
3177@end example
3178
3179The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3180agenda buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
dbc28aaa
CD
3181
3182@kindex C-u C-c C-t
3183@item C-u C-c C-t
3184Select a specific keyword using completion or (if it has been set up)
28a16a1b 3185the fast selection interface. For the latter, you need to assign keys
c8d0cf5c 3186to TODO states, see @ref{Per-file keywords}, and @ref{Setting tags}, for
28a16a1b 3187more information.
dbc28aaa 3188
4009494e
GM
3189@kindex S-@key{right}
3190@kindex S-@key{left}
c8d0cf5c 3191@vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
4009494e
GM
3192@item S-@key{right}
3193@itemx S-@key{left}
dbc28aaa
CD
3194Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
3195mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
c8d0cf5c
CD
3196extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
3197with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
3198@code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
4009494e 3199@kindex C-c C-v
dbc28aaa 3200@kindex C-c / t
4009494e
GM
3201@cindex sparse tree, for TODO
3202@item C-c C-v
dbc28aaa 3203@itemx C-c / t
c8d0cf5c
CD
3204@vindex org-todo-keywords
3205View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
3206entire buffer, but shows all TODO items and the headings hierarchy above
3207them. With a prefix argument, search for a specific TODO. You will be
4009494e 3208prompted for the keyword, and you can also give a list of keywords like
c8d0cf5c
CD
3209@code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list entries that match any one of these keywords.
3210With numeric prefix argument N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the
3211variable @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO
3212and DONE entries.
4009494e
GM
3213@kindex C-c a t
3214@item C-c a t
dbc28aaa 3215Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items from all agenda
a7808fba 3216files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new buffer will
dbc28aaa
CD
3217be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
3218manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda
3219commands}). @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
4009494e
GM
3220@kindex S-M-@key{RET}
3221@item S-M-@key{RET}
3222Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
3223@end table
3224
71d35b24 3225@noindent
c8d0cf5c 3226@vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
71d35b24
CD
3227Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
3228option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
3229
a7808fba 3230@node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
4009494e
GM
3231@section Extended use of TODO keywords
3232@cindex extended TODO keywords
3233
c8d0cf5c 3234@vindex org-todo-keywords
dbc28aaa 3235By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
a7808fba 3236DONE. Org mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
dbc28aaa
CD
3237with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
3238special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
3239files.
4009494e
GM
3240
3241Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
3242TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
3243
3244@menu
3245* Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
dbc28aaa 3246* TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
4009494e 3247* Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
dbc28aaa
CD
3248* Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
3249* Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
3250* Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
ec712abb 3251* TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
4009494e
GM
3252@end menu
3253
3254@node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
3255@subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
3256@cindex TODO workflow
3257@cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
3258
3259You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
3260in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
a7808fba 3261this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org mode in a
4009494e
GM
3262buffer.}:
3263
3264@lisp
3265(setq org-todo-keywords
3266 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
3267@end lisp
3268
3269The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
44ce9197 3270action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
4009494e
GM
3271you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
3272state.
3273@cindex completion, of TODO keywords
3274With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
3275to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED. You may
a7808fba 3276also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
4009494e 3277example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY.
560bb6ea 3278Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
28a16a1b
CD
3279define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
3280(@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
3281(@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
a7808fba 3282buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
c8d0cf5c 3283@ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
4009494e
GM
3284
3285@node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
3286@subsection TODO keywords as types
3287@cindex TODO types
3288@cindex names as TODO keywords
3289@cindex types as TODO keywords
3290
3291The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
3292@emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
3293that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
3294people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
3295directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
3296be set up like this:
3297
3298@lisp
3299(setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
3300@end lisp
3301
3302In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
3303different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
a7808fba
CD
3304person, and later to mark it DONE. Org mode supports this style by adapting
3305the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
3306@kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
3307times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
3308select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
3309time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
3310to DONE. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
3311name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
3312by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c C-v}. For example, to see all things
3313Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c C-v}. To collect Lucy's items
3314from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
3315argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c t}.
4009494e 3316
dbc28aaa 3317@node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
4009494e 3318@subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
a7808fba 3319@cindex TODO keyword sets
4009494e
GM
3320
3321Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
3322parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
3323@code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
3324separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
3325DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
3326like this:
3327
3328@lisp
3329(setq org-todo-keywords
3330 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
3331 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
3332 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
3333@end lisp
3334
a7808fba 3335The keywords should all be different, this helps Org mode to keep track
4009494e
GM
3336of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
3337@kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
3338@code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
3339(nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
3340select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
3341keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
3342
3343@table @kbd
3344@kindex C-S-@key{right}
3345@kindex C-S-@key{left}
3da3282e
CD
3346@kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
3347@item C-u C-u C-c C-t
3348@itemx C-S-@key{right}
4009494e
GM
3349@itemx C-S-@key{left}
3350These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
3da3282e
CD
3351@kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
3352@code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
3353@code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
3354@code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
4009494e
GM
3355@kindex S-@key{right}
3356@kindex S-@key{left}
3357@item S-@key{right}
3358@itemx S-@key{left}
3da3282e
CD
3359@kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
3360keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
3361from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
c8d0cf5c 3362@ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3da3282e 3363@code{shift-selection-mode}.
4009494e
GM
3364@end table
3365
dbc28aaa
CD
3366@node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
3367@subsection Fast access to TODO states
3368
3369If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
3370instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for
3371single-letter access to the states. This is done by adding the section
c8d0cf5c 3372key after each keyword, in parentheses. For example:
dbc28aaa
CD
3373
3374@lisp
3375(setq org-todo-keywords
3376 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
3377 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
3378 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
3379@end lisp
3380
c8d0cf5c 3381@vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
55033558
CD
3382If you then press @code{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
3383will be switched to this state. @key{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
3384keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the variable
c8d0cf5c 3385@code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
55033558
CD
3386state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
3387mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
3388unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
dbc28aaa
CD
3389
3390@node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
4009494e
GM
3391@subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
3392@cindex keyword options
dbc28aaa 3393@cindex per-file keywords
c8d0cf5c
CD
3394@cindex #+TODO
3395@cindex #+TYP_TODO
3396@cindex #+SEQ_TODO
4009494e
GM
3397
3398It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
3399different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
3400to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
3401only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
3402need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
3403file:
3404
3405@example
c8d0cf5c 3406#+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
4009494e 3407@end example
c8d0cf5c
CD
3408@noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
3409interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
4009494e
GM
3410@example
3411#+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
3412@end example
3413
3414A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
3415
3416@example
c8d0cf5c
CD
3417#+TODO: TODO | DONE
3418#+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
3419#+TODO: | CANCELED
4009494e
GM
3420@end example
3421
3422@cindex completion, of option keywords
3423@kindex M-@key{TAB}
3424@noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
3425@samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
3426
3427@cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
3428Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
3429if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
3430may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
3431@kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
a7808fba
CD
3432known to Org mode@footnote{Org mode parses these lines only when
3433Org mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3434cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org mode
4009494e
GM
3435for the current buffer.}.
3436
7ddb1b5f 3437@node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
dbc28aaa
CD
3438@subsection Faces for TODO keywords
3439@cindex faces, for TODO keywords
3440
c8d0cf5c
CD
3441@vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
3442@vindex org-done @r{(face)}
3443@vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
a7808fba 3444Org mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
dbc28aaa
CD
3445for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
3446@code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
3447you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
3448special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
3449@code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
3450
3451@lisp
96c8522a 3452@group
dbc28aaa
CD
3453(setq org-todo-keyword-faces
3454 '(("TODO" . org-warning)
3455 ("DEFERRED" . shadow)
3456 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
96c8522a 3457@end group
dbc28aaa
CD
3458@end lisp
3459
28a16a1b
CD
3460While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED
3461@emph{should} work, this does not aways seem to be the case. If
3462necessary, define a special face and use that.
3463
7ddb1b5f
CD
3464@node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
3465@subsection TODO dependencies
2e461fc1
CD
3466@cindex TODO dependencies
3467@cindex dependencies, of TODO states
7ddb1b5f 3468
c8d0cf5c
CD
3469@vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
3470@cindex property, ORDERED
7ddb1b5f
CD
3471The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
3472dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
3473all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE. And sometimes
3474there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
3475cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
3476the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
2e461fc1
CD
3477from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE.
3478Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
3479will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE. Here is an
3480example:
7ddb1b5f
CD
3481
3482@example
3483* TODO Blocked until (two) is done
3484** DONE one
3485** TODO two
3486
3487* Parent
3488 :PROPERTIES:
3489 :ORDERED: t
3490 :END:
3491** TODO a
3492** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
3493** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
3494@end example
3495
bc283609
CD
3496@table @kbd
3497@kindex C-c C-x o
3498@item C-c C-x o
c8d0cf5c
CD
3499@vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
3500@cindex property, ORDERED
3501Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
3502for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
3503inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
3504this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
3505@code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
2e461fc1
CD
3506@kindex C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t
3507@item C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t
c8d0cf5c 3508Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
bc283609
CD
3509@end table
3510
c8d0cf5c 3511@vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
7ddb1b5f
CD
3512If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
3513that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
3514font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
3515
2e461fc1 3516@cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
c8d0cf5c 3517@vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
2e461fc1
CD
3518You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
3519(@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable
3520@code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
3521checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
3522
7ddb1b5f
CD
3523If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
3524between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
3525module @file{org-depend.el}.
3526
dbc28aaa 3527@page
a7808fba
CD
3528@node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
3529@section Progress logging
dbc28aaa
CD
3530@cindex progress logging
3531@cindex logging, of progress
3532
c8d0cf5c 3533Org mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
28a16a1b
CD
3534you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
3535a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
3536per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
3537information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
3538work time}.
dbc28aaa
CD
3539
3540@menu
3541* Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
3542* Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
a351880d 3543* Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
dbc28aaa
CD
3544@end menu
3545
3546@node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
3547@subsection Closing items
3548
28a16a1b
CD
3549The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
3550item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
3551in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}.
dbc28aaa
CD
3552
3553@lisp
28a16a1b 3554(setq org-log-done 'time)
dbc28aaa
CD
3555@end lisp
3556
3557@noindent
28a16a1b
CD
3558Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
3559of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
3560just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
3561through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
3562want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
3563corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
dbc28aaa
CD
3564
3565@lisp
28a16a1b 3566(setq org-log-done 'note)
dbc28aaa
CD
3567@end lisp
3568
28a16a1b
CD
3569@noindent
3570You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
3571the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
3572
3573In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
a7808fba 3574(@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
28a16a1b
CD
3575display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
3576giving you an overview of what has been done.
3577
a351880d 3578@node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
dbc28aaa 3579@subsection Tracking TODO state changes
c8d0cf5c
CD
3580@cindex drawer, for state change recording
3581
3582@vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
3583@vindex org-log-into-drawer
3584@cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
3585When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
3586might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
3587note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
3588time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
3589headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable
3590@code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
3591want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
3592Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this
3593behavior---the recommended drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}. You can
3594also overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
3595@code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
3596
3597Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org mode
3598expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
3599adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) and @samp{@@} (for a note)
3600in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the setting
dbc28aaa
CD
3601
3602@lisp
28a16a1b
CD
3603(setq org-todo-keywords
3604 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
dbc28aaa
CD
3605@end lisp
3606
3607@noindent
c8d0cf5c 3608@vindex org-log-done
28a16a1b 3609you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
c8d0cf5c
CD
3610request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
3611DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org mode will record two timestamps
28a16a1b 3612when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
c8d0cf5c 3613However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
28a16a1b
CD
3614both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
3615the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
c8d0cf5c 3616WAIT or CANCELED. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
28a16a1b 3617@samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
c8d0cf5c 3618entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
28a16a1b
CD
3619WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
3620logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
3621to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
3622when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
3623setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
3624configured.
3625
3626You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
3627to a buffer:
3628@example
c8d0cf5c 3629#+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
28a16a1b
CD
3630@end example
3631
c8d0cf5c 3632@cindex property, LOGGING
28a16a1b
CD
3633In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
3634single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
3635LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
3636on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
3637@code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
3638settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
3639
3640@example
3641* TODO Log each state with only a time
3642 :PROPERTIES:
3643 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
3644 :END:
3645* TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
3646 :PROPERTIES:
3647 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
3648 :END:
3649* TODO No logging at all
3650 :PROPERTIES:
3651 :LOGGING: nil
3652 :END:
dbc28aaa
CD
3653@end example
3654
a351880d
CD
3655@node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
3656@subsection Tracking your habits
3657@cindex habits
3658
3659Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
3660called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
3661
3662@enumerate
3663@item
3664You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable
3665@code{org-modules}.
3666@item
3667The habit is a TODO, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
3668@item
3669The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
3670@item
3671The TODO has a scheduled date, with a @code{.+} style repeat interval.
3672@item
3673The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
3674syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
3675three days, but at most every two days.
3676@item
3677You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled, in order
3678for historical data to be represented in the consistency graph. If it's not
3679enabled it's not an error, but the consistency graphs will be largely
3680meaningless.
3681@end enumerate
3682
3683To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
3684actual habit with some history:
3685
3686@example
3687** TODO Shave
3688 SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
3689 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
3690 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
3691 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
3692 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
3693 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
3694 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
3695 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
3696 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
3697 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
3698 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
3699 :PROPERTIES:
3700 :STYLE: habit
3701 :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
3702 :END:
3703@end example
3704
3705What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
3706@code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
3707today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
3708after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
3709after four days have elapsed.
3710
3711What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
3712consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
3713done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
3714past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
3715
3716@table @code
3717@item Blue
3718If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
3719@item Green
3720If the task could have been done on that day.
3721@item Yellow
3722If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
3723@item Red
3724If the task was overdue on that day.
3725@end table
3726
3727In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterix if
3728the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
3729the current day falls in the graph.
3730
3731There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
3732habits are displayed in the agenda.
3733
3734@table @code
3735@item org-habit-graph-column
3736The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
3737overwrite any text in that column, so it's a good idea to keep your habits'
3738titles brief and to the point.
3739@item org-habit-preceding-days
3740The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
3741@item org-habit-following-days
3742The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
3743@item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
3744If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
3745default.
3746@end table
3747
3748Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
3749temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
3750bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
3751which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
3752
a7808fba 3753@node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
4009494e
GM
3754@section Priorities
3755@cindex priorities
3756
a7808fba 3757If you use Org mode extensively, you may end up enough TODO items that
dbc28aaa
CD
3758it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
3759placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like
3760this
4009494e
GM
3761
3762@example
3763*** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
3764@end example
3765
3766@noindent
a7808fba 3767By default, Org mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
dbc28aaa
CD
3768@samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie
3769is treated as priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only in
a7808fba
CD
3770the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they have
3771no inherent meaning to Org mode.
dbc28aaa
CD
3772
3773Priorities can be attached to any outline tree entries; they do not need
3774to be TODO items.
4009494e
GM
3775
3776@table @kbd
3777@kindex @kbd{C-c ,}
3778@item @kbd{C-c ,}
3779Set the priority of the current headline. The command prompts for a
3780priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}. When you press
3781@key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the headline.
3782The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3783agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3784@c
3785@kindex S-@key{up}
3786@kindex S-@key{down}
3787@item S-@key{up}
3788@itemx S-@key{down}
c8d0cf5c 3789@vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
3da3282e 3790Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
c8d0cf5c
CD
3791@code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
3792also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
3793@ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3da3282e 3794@code{shift-selection-mode}.
4009494e
GM
3795@end table
3796
c8d0cf5c
CD
3797@vindex org-highest-priority
3798@vindex org-lowest-priority
3799@vindex org-default-priority
4009494e
GM
3800You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
3801@code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
3802@code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
3803these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
3804the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
3805priority):
3806
c8d0cf5c 3807@cindex #+PRIORITIES
4009494e
GM
3808@example
3809#+PRIORITIES: A C B
3810@end example
3811
a7808fba 3812@node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
4009494e
GM
3813@section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
3814@cindex tasks, breaking down
6eb02347 3815@cindex statistics, for TODO items
4009494e 3816
c8d0cf5c 3817@vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
4009494e 3818It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
b349f79f
CD
3819subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
3820with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
3821global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
3822the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
3823either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
6eb02347
CD
3824be updates each time the todo status of a child changes, or when pressing
3825@kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
b349f79f
CD
3826
3827@example
3828* Organize Party [33%]
3829** TODO Call people [1/2]
3830*** TODO Peter
3831*** DONE Sarah
3832** TODO Buy food
3833** DONE Talk to neighbor
3834@end example
3835
c8d0cf5c
CD
3836@cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
3837If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
3838the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
3839@code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
3840this issue.
3841
6eb02347
CD
3842@vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
3843If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
a351880d 3844subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
6eb02347
CD
3845@code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
3846include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
3847property.
3848
3849@example
3850* Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
3851 :PROPERTIES:
3852 :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
3853 :END:
3854@end example
3855
c8d0cf5c
CD
3856If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
3857when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
b349f79f
CD
3858
3859@example
3860(defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
3861 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
3862 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
3863 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
3864
3865(add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
3866@end example
3867
3868
3869Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
3870large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
4009494e
GM
3871
3872
a7808fba 3873@node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
4009494e
GM
3874@section Checkboxes
3875@cindex checkboxes
3876
dbc28aaa
CD
3877Every item in a plain list (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a
3878checkbox by starting it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is
a7808fba 3879similar to TODO items (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight.
dbc28aaa
CD
3880Checkboxes are not included into the global TODO list, so they are often
3881great to split a task into a number of simple steps. Or you can use
3882them in a shopping list. To toggle a checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or
3883use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's @file{org-mouse.el}).
3884
3885Here is an example of a checkbox list.
4009494e
GM
3886
3887@example
28a16a1b
CD
3888* TODO Organize party [2/4]
3889 - [-] call people [1/3]
4009494e
GM
3890 - [ ] Peter
3891 - [X] Sarah
3892 - [ ] Sam
3893 - [X] order food
3894 - [ ] think about what music to play
3895 - [X] talk to the neighbors
3896@end example
3897
28a16a1b
CD
3898Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
3899are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
3900parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
3901checked.
3902
4009494e
GM
3903@cindex statistics, for checkboxes
3904@cindex checkbox statistics
c8d0cf5c 3905@cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
6eb02347 3906@vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
c8d0cf5c
CD
3907The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
3908indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
3909and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
3910many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
3911be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
3912Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
3913headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable
6eb02347 3914@code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to
c8d0cf5c
CD
3915represent the all checkboxes below the cookie, not just the direct
3916children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
3917@samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
3918result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
3919the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
3920@samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
3921count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
3922will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
3923to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
3924
3925@cindex blocking, of checkboxes
3926@cindex checkbox blocking
3927@cindex property, ORDERED
3928If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
3929be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
3930off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
4009494e
GM
3931
3932@noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
3933
3934@table @kbd
3935@kindex C-c C-c
3936@item C-c C-c
c8d0cf5c
CD
3937Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
3938double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
3939intermediate state.
4009494e
GM
3940@kindex C-c C-x C-b
3941@item C-c C-x C-b
c8d0cf5c
CD
3942Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
3943double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
3944intermediate state.
4009494e
GM
3945@itemize @minus
3946@item
3947If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
7ddb1b5f
CD
3948and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
3949arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
4009494e
GM
3950@item
3951If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
3952this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
3953@item
3954If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
3955@end itemize
3956@kindex M-S-@key{RET}
3957@item M-S-@key{RET}
3958Insert a new item with a checkbox.
3959This works only if the cursor is already in a plain list item
3960(@pxref{Plain lists}).
c8d0cf5c
CD
3961@kindex C-c C-x o
3962@item C-c C-x o
3963@vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
3964@cindex property, ORDERED
3965Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
3966be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
3967this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
3968However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
3969for better visibility, customize the variable
3970@code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4009494e
GM
3971@kindex C-c #
3972@item C-c #
6eb02347
CD
3973Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
3974a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
3975updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
3976new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
3977changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
3978hand, use this command to get things back into sync. Or simply toggle any
3979entry twice (checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c}).
4009494e
GM
3980@end table
3981
a7808fba 3982@node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
4009494e
GM
3983@chapter Tags
3984@cindex tags
3985@cindex headline tagging
3986@cindex matching, tags
3987@cindex sparse tree, tag based
3988
dbc28aaa 3989An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
a7808fba 3990information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org mode has extensive
dbc28aaa 3991support for tags.
4009494e 3992
c8d0cf5c 3993@vindex org-tag-faces
dbc28aaa 3994Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
96c8522a 3995headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
a351880d 3996@samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
96c8522a 3997@samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
c8d0cf5c 3998Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
96c8522a 3999You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
c8d0cf5c 4000@code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
96c8522a 4001(@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
4009494e
GM
4002
4003@menu
4004* Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
4005* Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
4006* Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
4007@end menu
4008
4009@node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
4010@section Tag inheritance
dbc28aaa 4011@cindex tag inheritance
4009494e
GM
4012@cindex inheritance, of tags
4013@cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
4014
4015@i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
4016heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
4017well. For example, in the list
4018
4019@example
dbc28aaa
CD
4020* Meeting with the French group :work:
4021** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
4022*** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
4009494e
GM
4023@end example
4024
4025@noindent
dbc28aaa
CD
4026the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
4027@samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
b349f79f 4028explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
c8d0cf5c 4029a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
7006d207
CD
4030level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
4031with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
4032changes in the line.}:
b349f79f 4033
c8d0cf5c 4034@cindex #+FILETAGS
b349f79f
CD
4035@example
4036#+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
4037@end example
4038
4039@noindent
c8d0cf5c
CD
4040@vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
4041@vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
b349f79f 4042To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely, use
96c8522a
CD
4043the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and
4044@code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
b349f79f 4045
c8d0cf5c 4046@vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
b349f79f 4047When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
96c8522a 4048on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
07450bee 4049as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
96c8522a
CD
4050complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
4051of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
4052match in a subtree, configure the variable
4053@code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
4009494e
GM
4054
4055@node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
4056@section Setting tags
4057@cindex setting tags
4058@cindex tags, setting
4059
4060@kindex M-@key{TAB}
4061Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
4062After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
4063also a special command for inserting tags:
4064
4065@table @kbd
71d35b24
CD
4066@kindex C-c C-q
4067@item C-c C-q
4009494e 4068@cindex completion, of tags
c8d0cf5c 4069@vindex org-tags-column
a7808fba 4070Enter new tags for the current headline. Org mode will either offer
4009494e
GM
4071completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
4072below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
4073to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
4074tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
4075things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
4076demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
71d35b24
CD
4077@kindex C-c C-c
4078@item C-c C-c
4079When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
4009494e
GM
4080@end table
4081
c8d0cf5c 4082@vindex org-tag-alist
4009494e
GM
4083Org will support tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
4084default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
4085currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
4086of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
4087the default tags for a given file with lines like
4088
c8d0cf5c 4089@cindex #+TAGS
4009494e 4090@example
dbc28aaa
CD
4091#+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
4092#+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
4009494e
GM
4093@end example
4094
4095If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
4096variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
dbc28aaa 4097in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
4009494e
GM
4098
4099@example
4100#+TAGS:
4101@end example
4102
c8d0cf5c
CD
4103@vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
4104If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
4105in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
4106you may specify a list of tags with the variable
4107@code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
4108by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
4109
4110@example
4111#+STARTUP: noptag
4112@end example
4113
a7808fba
CD
4114By default Org mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
4115entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
4116method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
4117deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
4118assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
4119globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
4120@file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
4121different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
4122like:
4009494e
GM
4123
4124@lisp
dbc28aaa 4125(setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
4009494e
GM
4126@end lisp
4127
c8d0cf5c
CD
4128@noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
4129can instead set the TAGS option line as:
4009494e
GM
4130
4131@example
dbc28aaa 4132#+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
4009494e
GM
4133@end example
4134
c8d0cf5c
CD
4135@noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
4136window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
4137@samp{\n} into the tag list
4138
4139@example
4140#+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
4141@end example
4142
4143@noindent or write them in two lines:
4144
4145@example
4146#+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
4147#+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
4148@end example
4149
4009494e 4150@noindent
c8d0cf5c 4151You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
a7808fba 4152braces, as in:
4009494e
GM
4153
4154@example
dbc28aaa 4155#+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
4009494e
GM
4156@end example
4157
dbc28aaa 4158@noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
a7808fba 4159and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
4009494e
GM
4160
4161@noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
4162these lines to activate any changes.
4163
a7808fba 4164@noindent
c8d0cf5c 4165To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist},
a7808fba 4166you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
c8d0cf5c
CD
4167of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
4168break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
a7808fba
CD
4169configuration:
4170
4171@lisp
4172(setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
4173 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
4174 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
4175 (:endgroup . nil)
4176 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
4177@end lisp
4178
4179If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
4180automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
4181the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
4182corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
4183have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
4184keys:
4009494e
GM
4185
4186@table @kbd
4187@item a-z...
4188Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
4189tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
4190exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
4191@kindex @key{TAB}
4192@item @key{TAB}
4193Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
4194list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
4195@kindex @key{SPC}
4196@item @key{SPC}
4197Clear all tags for this line.
4198@kindex @key{RET}
4199@item @key{RET}
4200Accept the modified set.
4201@item C-g
4202Abort without installing changes.
4203@item q
4204If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
4205@item !
4206Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
4207exception) assign several tags from such a group.
4208@item C-c
4209Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
4210If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
4211selection window.
4212@end table
4213
4214@noindent
4215This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
dbc28aaa
CD
4216the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
4217@samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
4218C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
4219@samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
4009494e
GM
4220alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
4221@samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
4222@key{RET} @key{RET}}.
4223
c8d0cf5c
CD
4224@vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
4225If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
4009494e
GM
4226modify your list of tags, set the variable
4227@code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
c8d0cf5c 4228press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it will immediately exit
4009494e
GM
4229after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
4230@kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
4231(in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
4232C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
4233window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
4234when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
4235
4236@node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
4237@section Tag searches
4238@cindex tag searches
4239@cindex searching for tags
4240
dbc28aaa 4241Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
4009494e
GM
4242information into special lists.
4243
4244@table @kbd
4245@kindex C-c \
c8d0cf5c 4246@kindex C-c / m
4009494e 4247@item C-c \
c8d0cf5c 4248@itemx C-c / m
4009494e
GM
4249Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
4250@kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4251@kindex C-c a m
4252@item C-c a m
4253Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
4254@xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4255@kindex C-c a M
4256@item C-c a M
c8d0cf5c 4257@vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4009494e
GM
4258Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4259only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
4260@code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4261@end table
4262
c8d0cf5c
CD
4263These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
4264like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
4265@samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
4266which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
4267string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
4268and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
4269@ref{Matching tags and properties}.
dbc28aaa 4270
e45e3595 4271
a7808fba 4272@node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
4009494e
GM
4273@chapter Properties and Columns
4274@cindex properties
4275
4276Properties are a set of key-value pairs associated with an entry. There
a7808fba 4277are two main applications for properties in Org mode. First, properties
dbc28aaa 4278are like tags, but with a value. Second, you can use properties to
a7808fba 4279implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. For
dbc28aaa 4280an example of the first application, imagine maintaining a file where
c8d0cf5c 4281you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
dbc28aaa
CD
4282using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, one can use a
4283property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
4284values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. For an example of the second
a50253cc 4285application of properties, imagine keeping track of your music CDs,
c8d0cf5c 4286where properties could be things such as the album, artist, date of
dbc28aaa
CD
4287release, number of tracks, and so on.
4288
28a16a1b 4289Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
dbc28aaa
CD
4290(@pxref{Column view}).
4291
4009494e
GM
4292@menu
4293* Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
a7808fba 4294* Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
4009494e 4295* Property searches:: Matching property values
dbc28aaa 4296* Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
4009494e
GM
4297* Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
4298* Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
4299@end menu
4300
a7808fba
CD
4301@node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
4302@section Property syntax
4009494e
GM
4303@cindex property syntax
4304@cindex drawer, for properties
4305
4306Properties are key-value pairs. They need to be inserted into a special
4307drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
4308is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
4309first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
4310
4311@example
4312* CD collection
4313** Classic
4314*** Goldberg Variations
4315 :PROPERTIES:
4316 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4317 :Composer: J.S. Bach
28a16a1b 4318 :Artist: Glen Gould
c8d0cf5c 4319 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4009494e 4320 :NDisks: 1
28a16a1b 4321 :END:
4009494e
GM
4322@end example
4323
dbc28aaa
CD
4324You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
4325by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
4009494e
GM
4326@emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
4327the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
4328corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
4329errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
4330publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
4331
4332@example
4333* CD collection
4334 :PROPERTIES:
4335 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
64fb801f 4336 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
4009494e
GM
4337 :END:
4338@end example
4339
4340If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
4341file, use a line like
c8d0cf5c
CD
4342@cindex property, _ALL
4343@cindex #+PROPERTY
4009494e
GM
4344@example
4345#+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
4346@end example
4347
c8d0cf5c 4348@vindex org-global-properties
4009494e
GM
4349Property values set with the global variable
4350@code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
a7808fba 4351Org files.
4009494e
GM
4352
4353@noindent
4354The following commands help to work with properties:
4355
4356@table @kbd
4357@kindex M-@key{TAB}
4358@item M-@key{TAB}
4359After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
4360in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
dbc28aaa
CD
4361@kindex C-c C-x p
4362@item C-c C-x p
4363Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
4364necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
4009494e
GM
4365@item M-x org-insert-property-drawer
4366Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
4367inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
4368information like deadlines.
4369@kindex C-c C-c
4370@item C-c C-c
4371With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
4372@item C-c C-c s
4373Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
4374can be inserted using completion.
4375@kindex S-@key{right}
4376@kindex S-@key{left}
4377@item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
4378Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
4379@item C-c C-c d
4380Remove a property from the current entry.
4381@item C-c C-c D
4382Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
dbc28aaa
CD
4383@item C-c C-c c
4384Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
4385nearest column format definition.
4009494e
GM
4386@end table
4387
a7808fba
CD
4388@node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
4389@section Special properties
4009494e
GM
4390@cindex properties, special
4391
c8d0cf5c
CD
4392Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org mode
4393features, like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the
4394previous chapters. This interface exists so that you can include
4395these states in a column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in
dbc28aaa
CD
4396queries. The following property names are special and should not be
4397used as keys in the properties drawer:
4009494e 4398
c8d0cf5c
CD
4399@cindex property, special, TODO
4400@cindex property, special, TAGS
4401@cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
4402@cindex property, special, CATEGORY
4403@cindex property, special, PRIORITY
4404@cindex property, special, DEADLINE
4405@cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
4406@cindex property, special, CLOSED
4407@cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
4408@cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
4409@cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
4410@c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
4411@cindex property, special, ITEM
4009494e
GM
4412@example
4413TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
4414TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
4415ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
c8d0cf5c 4416CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
4009494e
GM
4417PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
4418DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
c8d0cf5c
CD
4419SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
4420CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
4421TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
4422TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
dbc28aaa
CD
4423CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
4424 @r{must be run first to compute the values.}
c8d0cf5c 4425ITEM @r{The content of the entry.}
4009494e
GM
4426@end example
4427
a7808fba 4428@node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
4009494e
GM
4429@section Property searches
4430@cindex properties, searching
dbc28aaa 4431@cindex searching, of properties
4009494e 4432
a7808fba 4433To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
c8d0cf5c
CD
4434the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
4435@table @kbd
4436@kindex C-c \
4437@kindex C-c / m
4438@item C-c \
4439@itemx C-c / m
4440Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
4441@kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4442@kindex C-c a m
4443@item C-c a m
4444Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
4445@xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4446@kindex C-c a M
4447@item C-c a M
4448@vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4449Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4450only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
4451@code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4452@end table
a7808fba 4453
c8d0cf5c
CD
4454The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
4455properties}.
dbc28aaa
CD
4456
4457There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
4458single property:
4459
4460@table @kbd
4461@kindex C-c / p
4462@item C-c / p
4463Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
4464prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
4465is created with all entries that define this property with the given
4466value. If you enclose the value into curly braces, it is interpreted as
4467a regular expression and matched against the property values.
4468@end table
4469
a7808fba 4470@node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
dbc28aaa 4471@section Property Inheritance
a7808fba
CD
4472@cindex properties, inheritance
4473@cindex inheritance, of properties
dbc28aaa 4474
c8d0cf5c
CD
4475@vindex org-use-property-inheritance
4476The outline structure of Org-mode documents lends itself for an
4477inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
a7808fba 4478property, the children can inherit this property. Org mode does not
dbc28aaa
CD
4479turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
4480significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
4481useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
c8d0cf5c 4482@code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
a7808fba
CD
4483all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
4484that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
4485inherited properties.
dbc28aaa 4486
a7808fba 4487Org mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
dbc28aaa
CD
4488least for the special applications for which they are used:
4489
c8d0cf5c 4490@cindex property, COLUMNS
dbc28aaa
CD
4491@table @code
4492@item COLUMNS
4493The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
4494(@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
4495where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
4496point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
4497subtree from where columns view is turned on.
4498@item CATEGORY
c8d0cf5c 4499@cindex property, CATEGORY
dbc28aaa
CD
4500For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
4501applies to the entire subtree.
4502@item ARCHIVE
c8d0cf5c 4503@cindex property, ARCHIVE
dbc28aaa
CD
4504For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
4505location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
28a16a1b 4506@item LOGGING
c8d0cf5c 4507@cindex property, LOGGING
28a16a1b
CD
4508The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
4509subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
dbc28aaa
CD
4510@end table
4511
a7808fba
CD
4512@node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
4513@section Column view
4009494e
GM
4514
4515A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
c8d0cf5c 4516@emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
4009494e 4517table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
a7808fba 4518entries. Org mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
4009494e
GM
4519over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
4520into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
4521tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
4522view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
4523is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
4524headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
4525tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
a7808fba 4526Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
4009494e
GM
4527queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
4528
4529@menu
4530* Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
4531* Using column view:: How to create and use column view
a7808fba 4532* Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
4009494e
GM
4533@end menu
4534
4535@node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
a7808fba 4536@subsection Defining columns
4009494e
GM
4537@cindex column view, for properties
4538@cindex properties, column view
4539
4540Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
4541done by defining a column format line.
4542
4543@menu
4544* Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
4545* Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
4546@end menu
4547
4548@node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
4549@subsubsection Scope of column definitions
4550
4551To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
4552
c8d0cf5c 4553@cindex #+COLUMNS
4009494e
GM
4554@example
4555#+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
4556@end example
4557
dbc28aaa
CD
4558To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
4559@code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
4560
4009494e
GM
4561@example
4562** Top node for columns view
4563 :PROPERTIES:
4564 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
4565 :END:
4566@end example
4567
dbc28aaa 4568If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
4009494e
GM
4569for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
4570column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
4571you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
4572sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
4573deeper part of the tree.
4574
4575@node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
4576@subsubsection Column attributes
4577A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
4578definition looks like this:
4579
4580@example
c8d0cf5c 4581 %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
4009494e
GM
4582@end example
4583
4584@noindent
4585Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
4586optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
4587
4588@example
c8d0cf5c 4589@var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
72d803ad 4590 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
c8d0cf5c 4591@var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
72d803ad
CD
4592 @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
4593 @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
4009494e 4594(title) @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the}
72d803ad 4595 @r{property name is used.}
c8d0cf5c 4596@{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
72d803ad
CD
4597 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
4598 @r{Supported summary types are:}
4599 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
4600 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
4601 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
4602 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM:SS, plain numbers are hours.}
4603 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
4604 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
4605 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
4606 @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
4607 @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
4608 @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
4609 @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
4610 @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
4611 @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
4612 @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4613 @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4614 @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4009494e
GM
4615@end example
4616
4617@noindent
a351880d
CD
4618Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
4619include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
4620same summary information.
4621
4009494e
GM
4622Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
4623values.
4624
4625@example
7006d207 4626:COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
a351880d 4627 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
4009494e
GM
4628:Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
4629:Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
4630:Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
4631@end example
4632
c8d0cf5c 4633@noindent
4009494e 4634The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
a351880d 4635item itself, i.e. of the headline. You probably always should start the
28a16a1b
CD
4636column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
4637create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
4009494e
GM
4638@samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
4639field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
4640character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
4641to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
4642modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
dbc28aaa 4643be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
4009494e 4644expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
dbc28aaa
CD
4645an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
4646@samp{CLOCKSUM} column is special, it lists the sum of CLOCK intervals
4647in the subtree.
4009494e 4648
a7808fba
CD
4649@node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
4650@subsection Using column view
4009494e
GM
4651
4652@table @kbd
4653@tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
4654@kindex C-c C-x C-c
4655@item C-c C-x C-c
c8d0cf5c
CD
4656@vindex org-columns-default-format
4657Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
4658column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
a351880d 4659definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
c8d0cf5c
CD
4660searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
4661defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
4662for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
4663property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
4664@code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
4665and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
28a16a1b
CD
4666@kindex r
4667@item r
a7808fba 4668Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
28a16a1b
CD
4669@kindex g
4670@item g
4671Same as @kbd{r}.
4009494e
GM
4672@kindex q
4673@item q
4674Exit column view.
4675@tsubheading{Editing values}
4676@item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
4677Move through the column view from field to field.
4678@kindex S-@key{left}
4679@kindex S-@key{right}
4680@item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
4681Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
4682have to have specified allowed values for a property.
b349f79f
CD
4683@item 1..9,0
4684Directly select the nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
4009494e
GM
4685@kindex n
4686@kindex p
4687@itemx n / p
4688Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
4689@kindex e
4690@item e
4691Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
4692invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
4693property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
4694or fast selection interface will pop up.
dbc28aaa
CD
4695@kindex C-c C-c
4696@item C-c C-c
4697When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
4009494e
GM
4698@kindex v
4699@item v
4700View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
4701the column is smaller than that of the value.
4702@kindex a
4703@item a
4704Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
4705in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
4706found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
4707current column view.
4708@tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
4709@kindex <
4710@kindex >
4711@item < / >
4712Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
4713@kindex S-M-@key{right}
4714@item S-M-@key{right}
864c9740 4715Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
4009494e
GM
4716@kindex S-M-@key{left}
4717@item S-M-@key{left}
4718Delete the current column.
4719@end table
4720
a7808fba
CD
4721@node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
4722@subsection Capturing column view
dbc28aaa
CD
4723
4724Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
4725exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
c8d0cf5c 4726a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
28a16a1b 4727of this block looks like this:
dbc28aaa 4728
c8d0cf5c 4729@cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
dbc28aaa
CD
4730@example
4731* The column view
4732#+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
4733
4734#+END:
4735@end example
4736
4737@noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
4738
4739@table @code
4740@item :id
c8d0cf5c 4741This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
dbc28aaa 4742often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
c8d0cf5c
CD
4743at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
4744capture, you can use 4 values:
4745@cindex property, ID
dbc28aaa
CD
4746@example
4747local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
4748global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
c8d0cf5c 4749"file:@var{path-to-file}"
55e0839d 4750 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
c8d0cf5c 4751"@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
b349f79f
CD
4752 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
4753 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
4754 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
dbc28aaa
CD
4755@end example
4756@item :hlines
c8d0cf5c
CD
4757When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
4758an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
dbc28aaa 4759@item :vlines
c8d0cf5c 4760When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
28a16a1b
CD
4761@item :maxlevel
4762When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
4763@item :skip-empty-rows
c8d0cf5c 4764When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
28a16a1b
CD
4765column view is @code{ITEM}.
4766
dbc28aaa
CD
4767@end table
4768
4769@noindent
4770The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
4771
4772@table @kbd
864c9740
CD
4773@kindex C-c C-x i
4774@item C-c C-x i
dbc28aaa 4775Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
c8d0cf5c 4776for the scope or ID of the view.
dbc28aaa
CD
4777@kindex C-c C-c
4778@item C-c C-c
4779@kindex C-c C-x C-u
4780@itemx C-c C-x C-u
c8d0cf5c 4781Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
dbc28aaa
CD
4782@code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
4783@kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
4784@item C-u C-c C-x C-u
4785Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
a7808fba 4786you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
dbc28aaa
CD
4787@end table
4788
864c9740 4789You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
c8d0cf5c 4790instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
864c9740
CD
4791block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
4792actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
4793
c8d0cf5c
CD
4794An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
4795provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
4796package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
4797distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
4798@uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
4799properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
4800process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
4801
a7808fba 4802@node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
4009494e
GM
4803@section The Property API
4804@cindex properties, API
4805@cindex API, for properties
4806
4807There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
4808be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
4809features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
4810property API}.
4811
a351880d 4812@node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
dbc28aaa
CD
4813@chapter Dates and Times
4814@cindex dates
4815@cindex times
c8d0cf5c
CD
4816@cindex timestamp
4817@cindex date stamp
4009494e 4818
dbc28aaa
CD
4819To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
4820a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
a7808fba 4821information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org mode. This may be a
dbc28aaa 4822little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
a7808fba 4823something was created or last changed. However, in Org mode this term
dbc28aaa 4824is used in a much wider sense.
4009494e
GM
4825
4826@menu
a7808fba 4827* Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
4009494e
GM
4828* Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
4829* Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
a7808fba 4830* Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
a351880d 4831* Resolving idle time:: Resolving time if you've been idle
a7808fba 4832* Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
96c8522a 4833* Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
4009494e
GM
4834@end menu
4835
4836
a7808fba 4837@node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
c8d0cf5c
CD
4838@section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
4839@cindex timestamps
4009494e
GM
4840@cindex ranges, time
4841@cindex date stamps
4842@cindex deadlines
4843@cindex scheduling
4844
7006d207
CD
4845A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
4846times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>} or
4009494e 4847@samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue
7006d207
CD
484812:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 6801 date/time
4849format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time format}.}. A
4850timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org tree entry.
4851Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the agenda
a7808fba 4852(@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
4009494e
GM
4853
4854@table @var
c8d0cf5c 4855@item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
4009494e 4856@cindex timestamp
c8d0cf5c 4857A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
dbc28aaa
CD
4858like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
4859timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
c8d0cf5c 4860plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
4009494e
GM
4861
4862@example
4863* Meet Peter at the movies <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
4864* Discussion on climate change <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
4865@end example
4866
c8d0cf5c 4867@item Timestamp with repeater interval
4009494e 4868@cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
c8d0cf5c 4869A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
4009494e 4870applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
c8d0cf5c 4871interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
4009494e
GM
4872following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
4873
4874@example
4875* Pick up Sam at school <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
4876@end example
4877
4878@item Diary-style sexp entries
a7808fba 4879For more complex date specifications, Org mode supports using the
4009494e
GM
4880special sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
4881package. For example
4882
4883@example
4884* The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
4885 <%%(diary-float t 4 2)>
4886@end example
4887
4888@item Time/Date range
4889@cindex timerange
4890@cindex date range
c8d0cf5c 4891Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
4009494e
GM
4892will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
4893that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
4894
4895@example
4896** Meeting in Amsterdam
4897 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
4898@end example
4899
c8d0cf5c 4900@item Inactive timestamp
4009494e
GM
4901@cindex timestamp, inactive
4902@cindex inactive timestamp
c8d0cf5c
CD
4903Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
4904angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
4009494e
GM
4905@emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
4906
4907@example
4908* Gillian comes late for the fifth time [2006-11-01 Wed]
4909@end example
4910
4911@end table
4912
a7808fba 4913@node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
4009494e
GM
4914@section Creating timestamps
4915@cindex creating timestamps
4916@cindex timestamps, creating
4917
c8d0cf5c
CD
4918For Org mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
4919format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
4009494e
GM
4920format.
4921
4922@table @kbd
4923@kindex C-c .
4924@item C-c .
c8d0cf5c
CD
4925Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
4926at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
864c9740
CD
4927timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
4928succession, a time range is inserted.
4009494e 4929@c
4009494e
GM
4930@kindex C-c !
4931@item C-c !
c8d0cf5c 4932Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
4009494e
GM
4933an agenda entry.
4934@c
c8d0cf5c
CD
4935@kindex C-u C-c .
4936@kindex C-u C-c !
4937@item C-u C-c .
4938@itemx C-u C-c !
4939@vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
4940Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
4941contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
4942minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
4943@c
4009494e
GM
4944@kindex C-c <
4945@item C-c <
c8d0cf5c 4946Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
4009494e
GM
4947@c
4948@kindex C-c >
4949@item C-c >
4950Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
a7808fba 4951timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
4009494e
GM
4952instead.
4953@c
4954@kindex C-c C-o
4955@item C-c C-o
c8d0cf5c 4956Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
a7808fba 4957point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
4009494e
GM
4958@c
4959@kindex S-@key{left}
4960@kindex S-@key{right}
4961@item S-@key{left}
4962@itemx S-@key{right}
4963Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
c8d0cf5c 4964shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
4009494e
GM
4965@c
4966@kindex S-@key{up}
4967@kindex S-@key{down}
4968@item S-@key{up}
4969@itemx S-@key{down}
4970Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
c8d0cf5c
CD
4971year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
4972like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
4973shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
4974the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
4975timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
4976(@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
4977related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
4009494e
GM
4978@c
4979@kindex C-c C-y
4980@cindex evaluate time range
4981@item C-c C-y
a7808fba
CD
4982Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
4983With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
4984the following column).
4009494e
GM
4985@end table
4986
4987
4988@menu
a7808fba
CD
4989* The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
4990* Custom time format:: Making dates look different
4009494e
GM
4991@end menu
4992
4993@node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
4994@subsection The date/time prompt
4995@cindex date, reading in minibuffer
4996@cindex time, reading in minibuffer
4997
c8d0cf5c 4998@vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
7006d207
CD
4999When Org mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
5000date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
5001format. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or
5002time information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
dbc28aaa 5003can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
7006d207
CD
5004copied from an email message. Org mode will find whatever information is in
5005there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
5006and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
5007modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
5008range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
5009information, Org mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
5010date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
5011@i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
a351880d
CD
5012variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
5013the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
5014tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
5015time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
dbc28aaa 5016
07450bee 5017For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
a7808fba 5018various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org mode are
dbc28aaa
CD
5019in @b{bold}.
5020
5021@example
50223-2-5 --> 2003-02-05
502314 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
502412 --> @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
5025Fri --> nearest Friday (defaultdate or later)
07450bee 5026sep 15 --> @b{2006}-09-15
dbc28aaa
CD
5027feb 15 --> @b{2007}-02-15
5028sep 12 9 --> 2009-09-12
502912:45 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
503022 sept 0:34 --> @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
a7808fba
CD
5031w4 --> ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
50322012 w4 fri --> Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
50332012-w04-5 --> Same as above
dbc28aaa
CD
5034@end example
5035
5036Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
5037@emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
c8d0cf5c 5038letter ([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
dbc28aaa
CD
5039single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
5040double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
5041a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
a351880d 5042the nth such day. E.g.
dbc28aaa
CD
5043
5044@example
b349f79f
CD
5045+0 --> today
5046. --> today
dbc28aaa
CD
5047+4d --> four days from today
5048+4 --> same as above
5049+2w --> two weeks from today
5050++5 --> five days from default date
c8d0cf5c 5051+2tue --> second Tuesday from now.
4009494e
GM
5052@end example
5053
c8d0cf5c
CD
5054@vindex parse-time-months
5055@vindex parse-time-weekdays
4009494e
GM
5056The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
5057you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
5058the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
5059
5060@cindex calendar, for selecting date
c8d0cf5c 5061@vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
4009494e
GM
5062Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
5063you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
5064@code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
5065prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
5066@key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
5067information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
5068from the minibuffer:
5069
4009494e 5070@kindex <
4009494e 5071@kindex >
4009494e 5072@kindex mouse-1
4009494e 5073@kindex S-@key{right}
4009494e 5074@kindex S-@key{left}
4009494e 5075@kindex S-@key{down}
4009494e 5076@kindex S-@key{up}
4009494e 5077@kindex M-S-@key{right}
4009494e 5078@kindex M-S-@key{left}
4009494e 5079@kindex @key{RET}
dbc28aaa
CD
5080@example
5081> / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
5082mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
5083S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
5084S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
5085M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
5086@key{RET} @r{Choose date in calendar.}
5087@end example
5088
c8d0cf5c 5089@vindex org-read-date-display-live
a7808fba
CD
5090The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
5091will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
5092way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
5093on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
5094minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
5095@code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
4009494e
GM
5096
5097@node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
5098@subsection Custom time format
5099@cindex custom date/time format
5100@cindex time format, custom
5101@cindex date format, custom
5102
c8d0cf5c
CD
5103@vindex org-display-custom-times
5104@vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
a7808fba 5105Org mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
4009494e
GM
5106defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
5107representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
5108customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
5109@code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
5110
5111@table @kbd
5112@kindex C-c C-x C-t
5113@item C-c C-x C-t
5114Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
5115@end table
5116
5117@noindent
a7808fba 5118Org mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
c8d0cf5c 5119format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
4009494e
GM
5120@emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
5121following consequences:
5122@itemize @bullet
28a16a1b 5123@item
c8d0cf5c 5124You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
4009494e
GM
5125after.
5126@item
5127The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
c8d0cf5c 5128each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
4009494e
GM
5129the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
5130just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
5131time will be changed by one minute.
5132@item
c8d0cf5c 5133If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
4009494e
GM
5134will not be overlayed, but remain in the buffer as they were.
5135@item
c8d0cf5c 5136When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
4009494e
GM
5137disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
5138belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
5139@item
c8d0cf5c 5140If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
4009494e
GM
5141using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
5142format is shorter, things do work as expected.
5143@end itemize
5144
5145
a7808fba
CD
5146@node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
5147@section Deadlines and scheduling
4009494e 5148
c8d0cf5c 5149A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
4009494e
GM
5150
5151@table @var
5152@item DEADLINE
5153@cindex DEADLINE keyword
dbc28aaa
CD
5154
5155Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
5156to be finished on that date.
5157
c8d0cf5c 5158@vindex org-deadline-warning-days
dbc28aaa
CD
5159On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
5160addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
5161approaching or missed deadline, starting
5162@code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
5163until the entry is marked DONE. An example:
4009494e
GM
5164
5165@example
5166*** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
5167 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
5168 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
5169@end example
5170
5171You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
5172deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
5173period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
5174
5175@item SCHEDULED
5176@cindex SCHEDULED keyword
dbc28aaa
CD
5177
5178Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
5179date.
5180
c8d0cf5c 5181@vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
dbc28aaa
CD
5182The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
5183be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE. If you don't like
4009494e
GM
5184this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
5185addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
5186in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE.
a351880d 5187I.e. the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
4009494e
GM
5188
5189@example
5190*** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
5191 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
5192@end example
dbc28aaa
CD
5193
5194@noindent
a7808fba 5195@b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org mode should @i{not} be
dbc28aaa
CD
5196understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
5197Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
c8d0cf5c
CD
5198mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
5199on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
5200Org users. In Org mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
dbc28aaa 5201want to start working on an action item.
4009494e
GM
5202@end table
5203
c8d0cf5c 5204You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
a7808fba 5205entries. Org mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
c8d0cf5c 5206assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
dbc28aaa
CD
5207the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
5208@c
5209@code{<%%(diary-float t 42)>}
5210@c
a7808fba 5211in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org mode does not
dbc28aaa
CD
5212know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
5213late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
5214sexp entry matches.
5215
4009494e
GM
5216@menu
5217* Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
5218* Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
5219@end menu
5220
5221@node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
a7808fba 5222@subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
4009494e 5223
c8d0cf5c 5224The following commands allow you to quickly insert a deadline or to schedule
4009494e
GM
5225an item:
5226
5227@table @kbd
5228@c
5229@kindex C-c C-d
5230@item C-c C-d
a351880d
CD
5231Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
5232in the line directly following the headline. When called with a prefix arg,
5233an existing deadline will be removed from the entry. Depending on the
5234variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
5235@code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
5236and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5237deadline.
4009494e
GM
5238@c FIXME Any CLOSED timestamp will be removed.????????
5239@c
4009494e
GM
5240@kindex C-c C-s
5241@item C-c C-s
5242Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
a351880d
CD
5243happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
5244will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
5245date from the entry. Depending on the variable
5246@code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
5247keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline}, and
5248@code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5249scheduling time.
b349f79f
CD
5250@c
5251@kindex C-c C-x C-k
5252@kindex k a
5253@kindex k s
5254@item C-c C-x C-k
5255Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
5256like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
5257date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
5258schedule the marked item.
c8d0cf5c
CD
5259@c
5260@kindex C-c / d
5261@cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
5262@item C-c / d
5263@vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5264Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
5265which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
5266With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
5267prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
5268all deadlines due tomorrow.
5269@c
5270@kindex C-c / b
5271@item C-c / b
5272Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
5273@c
5274@kindex C-c / a
5275@item C-c / a
5276Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
4009494e
GM
5277@end table
5278
5279@node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
a7808fba 5280@subsection Repeated tasks
c8d0cf5c
CD
5281@cindex tasks, repeated
5282@cindex repeated tasks
4009494e 5283
a7808fba 5284Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org mode helps to
28a16a1b 5285organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
c8d0cf5c 5286or plain timestamp. In the following example
4009494e
GM
5287@example
5288** TODO Pay the rent
5289 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
5290@end example
c8d0cf5c
CD
5291@noindent
5292the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
5293has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
5294from that time. If you need both a repeater and a special warning period in
5295a deadline entry, the repeater should come first and the warning period last:
5296@code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
4009494e
GM
5297
5298Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they
5299are over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as
5300completed once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE
a7808fba 5301with the TODO keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the
28a16a1b 5302agenda. The problem with this is, however, that then also the
a7808fba 5303@emph{next} instance of the repeated entry will not be active. Org mode
4009494e
GM
5304deals with this in the following way: When you try to mark such an entry
5305DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will shift the base date of the repeating
c8d0cf5c 5306timestamp by the repeater interval, and immediately set the entry state
4009494e
GM
5307back to TODO. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would
5308actually switch the date like this:
5309
5310@example
5311** TODO Pay the rent
5312 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
5313@end example
5314
c8d0cf5c 5315@vindex org-log-repeat
a7808fba
CD
5316A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
5317@code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
5318@code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
a50253cc 5319will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
a7808fba 5320a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
4009494e
GM
5321
5322As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
5323visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
5324will be visible.
5325
28a16a1b 5326With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
c8d0cf5c 5327month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
28a16a1b
CD
5328entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
5329task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
5330forgot to call you father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
a7808fba 5331him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
28a16a1b 5332like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
a7808fba
CD
5333@i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org mode has
5334special repeaters markers with @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
28a16a1b
CD
5335
5336@example
5337** TODO Call Father
5338 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
5339 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
5340 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
5341 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
5342 and marked it done on Saturday.
5343** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
5344 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
5345 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
5346 today.
5347@end example
5348
4009494e 5349You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
c8d0cf5c
CD
5350task---just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
5351
5352An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
5353subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
5354created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
5355
4009494e 5356
a351880d 5357@node Clocking work time, Resolving idle time, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
dbc28aaa 5358@section Clocking work time
4009494e 5359
c8d0cf5c 5360Org mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
4009494e
GM
5361project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock.
5362When you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the
5363clock is stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It
a351880d
CD
5364also computes the total time spent on each subtree of a project. And it
5365remembers a history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly
5366between a number of tasks absorbing your time.
c8d0cf5c 5367
a351880d 5368To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
c8d0cf5c 5369@lisp
a351880d 5370(setq org-clock-persist 'history)
c8d0cf5c
CD
5371(org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
5372@end lisp
a351880d
CD
5373When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
5374clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
5375on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
5376will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
5377what to do with it.
c8d0cf5c 5378
4009494e
GM
5379@table @kbd
5380@kindex C-c C-x C-i
5381@item C-c C-x C-i
c8d0cf5c 5382@vindex org-clock-into-drawer
4009494e 5383Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
dbc28aaa
CD
5384keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
5385this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
c8d0cf5c 5386@code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
a7808fba
CD
5387@code{org-clock-into-drawer}). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
5388select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
5389C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task.
5390The default task will always be available when selecting a clocking task,
c8d0cf5c
CD
5391with letter @kbd{d}.@*
5392@cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
5393@cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
5394@vindex org-clock-modeline-total
5395While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
5396line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
5397time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
5398estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
5399clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
5400hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
5401is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
5402reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
5403will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
5404the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
5405@code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
5406show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
5407@code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
5408@code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
5409@code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
5410mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
4009494e
GM
5411@kindex C-c C-x C-o
5412@item C-c C-x C-o
c8d0cf5c 5413@vindex org-log-note-clock-out
a20d3598 5414Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
4009494e
GM
5415location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
5416the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
28a16a1b
CD
5417HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
5418possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
c8d0cf5c 5419timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
28a16a1b 5420@code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
c8d0cf5c
CD
5421@kindex C-c C-x C-e
5422@item C-c C-x C-e
5423Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
4009494e 5424@kindex C-c C-y
c8d0cf5c
CD
5425@kindex C-c C-c
5426@item C-c C-y @ @ @r{or}@ @ C-c C-c
5427Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
5428is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
4009494e
GM
5429them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
5430@kindex C-c C-t
5431@item C-c C-t
5432Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
5433if it is running in this same item.
5434@kindex C-c C-x C-x
5435@item C-c C-x C-x
5436Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
5437mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
dbc28aaa
CD
5438@kindex C-c C-x C-j
5439@item C-c C-x C-j
a7808fba
CD
5440Jump to the entry that contains the currently running clock. With a
5441@kbd{C-u} prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked
5442tasks.
4009494e
GM
5443@kindex C-c C-x C-d
5444@item C-c C-x C-d
c8d0cf5c 5445@vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
4009494e
GM
5446Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This
5447puts overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time
5448recorded under that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You
5449can use visibility cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear
5450when you change the buffer (see variable
5451@code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press @kbd{C-c C-c}.
5452@kindex C-c C-x C-r
5453@item C-c C-x C-r
5454Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
c8d0cf5c 5455report as an Org-mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
dbc28aaa
CD
5456at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
5457argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
5458update it.
c8d0cf5c 5459@cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
4009494e 5460@example
dbc28aaa 5461#+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
4009494e
GM
5462#+END: clocktable
5463@end example
5464@noindent
dbc28aaa
CD
5465If such a block already exists at point, its content is replaced by the
5466new table. The @samp{BEGIN} line can specify options:
4009494e 5467@example
dbc28aaa 5468:maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
c8d0cf5c 5469:emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
dbc28aaa
CD
5470:scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
5471 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
5472 file @r{the full current buffer}
5473 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
c8d0cf5c 5474 tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
dbc28aaa
CD
5475 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
5476 agenda @r{all agenda files}
5477 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
a7808fba
CD
5478 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
5479 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
5480:block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
5481 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
5482 @r{these formats:}
5483 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
5484 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
5485 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
5486 2007 @r{the year 2007}
c8d0cf5c
CD
5487 today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
5488 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
5489 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
5490 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
a7808fba 5491 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
c8d0cf5c
CD
5492:tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
5493:tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
a7808fba
CD
5494:step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
5495 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
c8d0cf5c 5496:link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
e45e3595 5497:formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
c8d0cf5c
CD
5498 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
5499 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula.}
e45e3595 5500 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
c8d0cf5c
CD
5501:timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
5502 @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
4009494e 5503@end example
c8d0cf5c 5504To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
dbc28aaa 5505day, you could write
4009494e 5506@example
a7808fba 5507#+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
4009494e
GM
5508#+END: clocktable
5509@end example
c8d0cf5c 5510@noindent
4009494e 5511and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
c8d0cf5c
CD
5512parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
5513only to fit it into the manual.}
4009494e 5514@example
28a16a1b 5515#+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
4009494e 5516 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
4009494e
GM
5517#+END: clocktable
5518@end example
e45e3595
CD
5519A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
5520@example
5521#+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
5522#+END: clocktable
5523@end example
dbc28aaa
CD
5524@kindex C-c C-c
5525@item C-c C-c
5526@kindex C-c C-x C-u
5527@itemx C-c C-x C-u
c8d0cf5c 5528Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
dbc28aaa 5529@code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
4009494e
GM
5530@kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
5531@item C-u C-c C-x C-u
5532Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
a7808fba
CD
5533you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
5534@kindex S-@key{left}
5535@kindex S-@key{right}
5536@item S-@key{left}
5537@itemx S-@key{right}
5538Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
5539needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
5540@code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
4009494e
GM
5541@end table
5542
5543The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
a7808fba 5544the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
4009494e
GM
5545worked on or closed during a day.
5546
a351880d
CD
5547@node Resolving idle time, Effort estimates, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
5548@section Resolving idle time
5549@cindex resolve idle time
5550
5551@cindex idle, resolve, dangling
5552If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
5553computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
5554time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
5555applying it to another one.
5556
5557@vindex org-clock-idle-time
5558By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
5559as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
5560being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
5561idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
5562X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
5563UTILITIES directory of the Org git distribution, to get the same general
5564treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs idle time
5565only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will be a
5566question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle time has
5567passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a set of
5568choices to correct the discrepancy:
5569
5570@table @kbd
5571@item k
5572To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
5573will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
5574effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
5575@item K
5576If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
5577you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
5578the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
5579@item s
5580To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
5581the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
5582@item S
5583To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
5584use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
5585leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
5586@item C
5587To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
5588cancelling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
5589than a minute, the clock will still be cancelled rather than clutter up the
5590log with an empty entry.
5591@end table
5592
5593What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
5594want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
5595after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
5596the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
5597the next task you clock in on.
5598
5599There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
5600were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
5601scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
5602lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
5603mode changes, including your last clock in.
5604
5605If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
5606dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
5607that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
5608Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
5609identical to dealing with away time due to idleness, it's just happening due
5610to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
5611
5612You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
5613clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks}.
5614
5615@node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Resolving idle time, Dates and Times
a7808fba 5616@section Effort estimates
96c8522a 5617@cindex effort estimates
a7808fba 5618
c8d0cf5c
CD
5619@cindex property, Effort
5620@vindex org-effort-property
a7808fba
CD
5621If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
5622produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
5623assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
5624may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
5625great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
5626special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
6eb02347
CD
5627used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
5628for an entry with the following commands:
5629
5630@table @kbd
5631@kindex C-c C-x e
5632@item C-c C-x e
5633Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
5634argument, set it to the NTH allowed value (see below). This command is also
5635accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
5636@kindex C-c C-x C-e
5637@item C-c C-x C-e
5638Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
5639@end table
5640
5641Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
5642(@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
5643effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
5644together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
5645buffer you can use
a7808fba
CD
5646
5647@example
5648#+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00 8:00
5649#+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
5650@end example
5651
5652@noindent
c8d0cf5c
CD
5653@vindex org-global-properties
5654@vindex org-columns-default-format
71d35b24
CD
5655or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
5656variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
5657In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
5658setup may be advised.
a7808fba
CD
5659
5660The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
5661mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
5662value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
5663In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
5664
c8d0cf5c 5665@vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
a7808fba
CD
5666If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
5667will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
5668the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
b349f79f 5669column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
a7808fba
CD
5670an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
5671option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
5672appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
5673then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
5674
71d35b24
CD
5675Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
5676with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
5677these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
5678down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
864c9740 5679
96c8522a
CD
5680@node Relative timer, , Effort estimates, Dates and Times
5681@section Taking notes with a relative timer
5682@cindex relative timer
5683
5684When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
5685be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
5686such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
5687
5688@table @kbd
5689@kindex C-c C-x .
5690@item C-c C-x .
5691Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
5692timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
5693restarted.
5694@kindex C-c C-x -
5695@item C-c C-x -
5696Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
5697argument, first reset the timer to 0.
5698@kindex M-@key{RET}
5699@item M-@key{RET}
377952e0 5700Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
96c8522a 5701new timer items.
55e0839d
CD
5702@kindex C-c C-x ,
5703@item C-c C-x ,
c8d0cf5c
CD
5704Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused.
5705@c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
55e0839d
CD
5706@kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
5707@item C-u C-c C-x ,
5708Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
5709old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
96c8522a
CD
5710@kindex C-c C-x 0
5711@item C-c C-x 0
5712Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
5713timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
5714specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
5715default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
5716restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
5717prefix argument @kbd{C-c C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
5718by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
5719not started at exactly the right moment.
5720@end table
5721
a351880d
CD
5722@node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
5723@chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
864c9740
CD
5724@cindex capture
5725
5726An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
5727capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
c8d0cf5c 5728Org uses the @file{remember.el} package to create tasks, and stores files
a351880d
CD
5729related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
5730system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
5731trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
864c9740
CD
5732
5733@menu
5734* Remember:: Capture new tasks/ideas with little interruption
5735* Attachments:: Add files to tasks.
c8d0cf5c 5736* RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
a351880d
CD
5737* Protocols:: External (e.g. Browser) access to Emacs and Org
5738* Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
5739* Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
864c9740
CD
5740@end menu
5741
a351880d 5742@node Remember, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
864c9740 5743@section Remember
dbc28aaa
CD
5744@cindex @file{remember.el}
5745
c8d0cf5c
CD
5746The Remember package by John Wiegley lets you store quick notes with little
5747interruption of your work flow. It is an excellent way to add new notes and
5748tasks to Org files. The @code{remember.el} package is part of Emacs 23, not
5749Emacs 22. See @uref{http://www.emacswiki.org/cgi-bin/wiki/RememberMode} for
5750more information.
5751
5752Org significantly expands the possibilities of Remember: you may define
5753templates for different note types, and associate target files and headlines
5754with specific templates. It also allows you to select the location where a
5755note should be stored interactively, on the fly.
dbc28aaa
CD
5756
5757@menu
7006d207 5758* Setting up Remember for Org:: Some code for .emacs to get things going
dbc28aaa
CD
5759* Remember templates:: Define the outline of different note types
5760* Storing notes:: Directly get the note to where it belongs
dbc28aaa
CD
5761@end menu
5762
c8d0cf5c
CD
5763@node Setting up Remember for Org, Remember templates, Remember, Remember
5764@subsection Setting up Remember for Org
dbc28aaa 5765
c8d0cf5c 5766The following customization will tell Remember to use Org files as
a7808fba 5767target, and to create annotations compatible with Org links.
dbc28aaa
CD
5768
5769@example
5770(org-remember-insinuate)
5771(setq org-directory "~/path/to/my/orgfiles/")
5772(setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
5773(define-key global-map "\C-cr" 'org-remember)
5774@end example
5775
c8d0cf5c 5776@noindent
dbc28aaa
CD
5777The last line binds the command @code{org-remember} to a global
5778key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c r} is only a
c8d0cf5c
CD
5779suggestion.}. @code{org-remember} basically just calls Remember,
5780but it makes a few things easier: if there is an active region, it will
5781automatically copy the region into the Remember buffer. It also allows
5782to jump to the buffer and location where Remember notes are being
5783stored: just call @code{org-remember} with a prefix argument. If you
a7808fba 5784use two prefix arguments, Org jumps to the location where the last
28a16a1b 5785remember note was stored.
dbc28aaa 5786
c8d0cf5c
CD
5787The Remember buffer will actually use @code{org-mode} as its major mode, so
5788that all editing features of Org mode are available. In addition to this, a
64fb801f
CD
5789minor mode @code{org-remember-mode} is turned on, for the single purpose that
5790you can use its keymap @code{org-remember-mode-map} to overwrite some of
c8d0cf5c 5791Org mode's key bindings.
64fb801f 5792
b349f79f 5793You can also call @code{org-remember} in a special way from the agenda,
c8d0cf5c
CD
5794using the @kbd{k r} key combination. With this access, any timestamps
5795inserted by the selected Remember template (see below) will default to
b349f79f
CD
5796the cursor date in the agenda, rather than to the current date.
5797
c8d0cf5c 5798@node Remember templates, Storing notes, Setting up Remember for Org, Remember
864c9740 5799@subsection Remember templates
c8d0cf5c 5800@cindex templates, for Remember
dbc28aaa 5801
a7808fba 5802In combination with Org, you can use templates to generate
c8d0cf5c 5803different types of Remember notes. For example, if you would like
dbc28aaa
CD
5804to use one template to create general TODO entries, another one for
5805journal entries, and a third one for collecting random ideas, you could
5806use:
5807
5808@example
5809(setq org-remember-templates
5810 '(("Todo" ?t "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a" "~/org/TODO.org" "Tasks")
5811 ("Journal" ?j "* %U %?\n\n %i\n %a" "~/org/JOURNAL.org")
5812 ("Idea" ?i "* %^@{Title@}\n %i\n %a" "~/org/JOURNAL.org" "New Ideas")))
5813@end example
5814
c8d0cf5c
CD
5815@vindex org-remember-default-headline
5816@vindex org-directory
dbc28aaa
CD
5817@noindent In these entries, the first string is just a name, and the
5818character specifies how to select the template. It is useful if the
b349f79f
CD
5819character is also the first letter of the name. The next string specifies
5820the template. Two more (optional) strings give the file in which, and the
a351880d
CD
5821headline under which, the new note should be stored. The file (if not
5822present or @code{nil}) defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}, the heading
5823to @code{org-remember-default-headline}. If the file name is not an absolute
5824path, it will be interpreted relative to @code{org-directory}.
5825
5826The heading can also be the symbols @code{top} or @code{bottom} to send notes
5827as level 1 entries to the beginning or end of the file, respectively. It may
5828also be the symbol @code{date-tree}. Then, a tree with year on level 1,
5829month on level 2 and day on level three will be build in the file, and the
5830entry will be filed into the tree under the current date@footnote{If the file
5831contains an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, the entire date tree will
5832be build under that entry.}
b349f79f
CD
5833
5834An optional sixth element specifies the contexts in which the user can select
5835the template. This element can be a list of major modes or a function.
5836@code{org-remember} will first check whether the function returns @code{t} or
c8d0cf5c 5837if we are in any of the listed major modes, and exclude templates for which
b349f79f
CD
5838this condition is not fulfilled. Templates that do not specify this element
5839at all, or that use @code{nil} or @code{t} as a value will always be
5840selectable.
28a16a1b
CD
5841
5842So for example:
5843
5844@example
5845(setq org-remember-templates
5846 '(("Bug" ?b "* BUG %?\n %i\n %a" "~/org/BUGS.org" "Bugs" (emacs-lisp-mode))
b349f79f 5847 ("Journal" ?j "* %U %?\n\n %i\n %a" "~/org/JOURNAL.org" "X" my-check)
28a16a1b
CD
5848 ("Idea" ?i "* %^@{Title@}\n %i\n %a" "~/org/JOURNAL.org" "New Ideas")))
5849@end example
5850
c8d0cf5c 5851@noindent
28a16a1b
CD
5852The first template will only be available when invoking @code{org-remember}
5853from an buffer in @code{emacs-lisp-mode}. The second template will only be
5854available when the function @code{my-check} returns @code{t}. The third
5855template will be proposed in any context.
5856
b349f79f
CD
5857When you call @kbd{M-x org-remember} (or @kbd{M-x remember}) to remember
5858something, Org will prompt for a key to select the template (if you have
dbc28aaa
CD
5859more than one template) and then prepare the buffer like
5860@example
5861* TODO
c8d0cf5c 5862 [[file:@var{link to where you called remember}]]
dbc28aaa
CD
5863@end example
5864
5865@noindent
6eb02347
CD
5866During expansion of the template, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you
5867need one of these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.}
5868allow dynamic insertion of content:
dbc28aaa 5869@example
c8d0cf5c 5870%^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
dbc28aaa
CD
5871 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
5872 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}}
5873 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
b349f79f
CD
5874%a @r{annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}}
5875%A @r{like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part}
5876%i @r{initial content, the region when remember is called with C-u.}
5877 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
c8d0cf5c
CD
5878%t @r{timestamp, date only}
5879%T @r{timestamp with date and time}
5880%u, %U @r{like the above, but inactive timestamps}
dbc28aaa
CD
5881%^t @r{like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}}
5882 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}}
5883%n @r{user name (taken from @code{user-full-name})}
a7808fba
CD
5884%c @r{Current kill ring head.}
5885%x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
5886%^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
5887%^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
dbc28aaa 5888%^g @r{prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
864c9740
CD
5889%k @r{title of currently clocked task}
5890%K @r{link to currently clocked task}
dbc28aaa 5891%^G @r{prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
c8d0cf5c 5892%^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}}
dbc28aaa 5893%:keyword @r{specific information for certain link types, see below}
c8d0cf5c
CD
5894%[@var{file}] @r{insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}}
5895%(@var{sexp}) @r{evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result}
dbc28aaa
CD
5896%! @r{immediately store note after completing the template}
5897 @r{(skipping the @kbd{C-c C-c} that normally triggers storing)}
b349f79f 5898%& @r{jump to target location immediately after storing note}
dbc28aaa
CD
5899@end example
5900
5901@noindent
5902For specific link types, the following keywords will be
5903defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
5904hyperlink types}), any property you store with
5905@code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in remember templates in a
5906similar way.}:
5907
c8d0cf5c 5908@vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
dbc28aaa
CD
5909@example
5910Link type | Available keywords
5911-------------------+----------------------------------------------
5912bbdb | %:name %:company
28a16a1b 5913bbdb | %::server %:port %:nick
dbc28aaa
CD
5914vm, wl, mh, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
5915 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
5916 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
28a16a1b 5917 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
dbc28aaa
CD
5918gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
5919w3, w3m | %:url
5920info | %:file %:node
5921calendar | %:date"
5922@end example
5923
5924@noindent
5925To place the cursor after template expansion use:
5926
5927@example
5928%? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
5929@end example
5930
5931@noindent
28a16a1b 5932If you change your mind about which template to use, call
dbc28aaa
CD
5933@code{org-remember} in the remember buffer. You may then select a new
5934template that will be filled with the previous context information.
5935
a351880d 5936@node Storing notes, , Remember templates, Remember
864c9740 5937@subsection Storing notes
dbc28aaa 5938
c8d0cf5c
CD
5939@vindex org-remember-clock-out-on-exit
5940When you are finished preparing a note with Remember, you have to press
b349f79f 5941@kbd{C-c C-c} to file the note away. If you have started the clock in the
c8d0cf5c 5942Remember buffer, you will first be asked if you want to clock out
b349f79f
CD
5943now@footnote{To avoid this query, configure the variable
5944@code{org-remember-clock-out-on-exit}.}. If you answer @kbd{n}, the clock
44ce9197 5945will continue to run after the note was filed away.
b349f79f
CD
5946
5947The handler will then store the note in the file and under the headline
c8d0cf5c 5948specified in the template, or it will use the default file and headline.
b349f79f 5949The window configuration will be restored, sending you back to the working
c8d0cf5c
CD
5950context before the call to Remember. To re-use the location found
5951during the last call to Remember, exit the Remember buffer with
a351880d 5952@kbd{C-0 C-c C-c}, i.e. specify a zero prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-c}.
864c9740
CD
5953Another special case is @kbd{C-2 C-c C-c} which files the note as a child of
5954the currently clocked item.
dbc28aaa 5955
c8d0cf5c 5956@vindex org-remember-store-without-prompt
dbc28aaa 5957If you want to store the note directly to a different place, use
c8d0cf5c 5958@kbd{C-1 C-c C-c} instead to exit Remember@footnote{Configure the
dbc28aaa 5959variable @code{org-remember-store-without-prompt} to make this behavior
c8d0cf5c
CD
5960the default.}. The handler will then first prompt for a target file---if
5961you press @key{RET}, the value specified for the template is used.
dbc28aaa 5962Then the command offers the headings tree of the selected file, with the
c8d0cf5c 5963cursor position at the default headline (if you specified one in the
dbc28aaa
CD
5964template). You can either immediately press @key{RET} to get the note
5965placed there. Or you can use the following keys to find a different
5966location:
5967@example
5968@key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
5969@key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
5970n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
5971f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
5972u @r{One level up.}
5973@c 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
5974@end example
5975@noindent
5976Pressing @key{RET} or @key{left} or @key{right}
5977then leads to the following result.
5978
c8d0cf5c 5979@vindex org-reverse-note-order
dbc28aaa
CD
5980@multitable @columnfractions 0.2 0.15 0.65
5981@item @b{Cursor position} @tab @b{Key} @tab @b{Note gets inserted}
5982@item on headline @tab @key{RET} @tab as sublevel of the heading at cursor, first or last
5983@item @tab @tab depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}.
5984@item @tab @key{left}/@key{right} @tab as same level, before/after current heading
5985@item buffer-start @tab @key{RET} @tab as level 2 heading at end of file or level 1 at beginning
5986@item @tab @tab depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}.
5987@item not on headline @tab @key{RET}
5988 @tab at cursor position, level taken from context.
5989@end multitable
5990
864c9740 5991Before inserting the text into a tree, the function ensures that the text has
a351880d 5992a headline, i.e. a first line that starts with a @samp{*}. If not, a
864c9740
CD
5993headline is constructed from the current date. If you have indented the text
5994of the note below the headline, the indentation will be adapted if inserting
5995the note into the tree requires demotion from level 1.
dbc28aaa 5996
c8d0cf5c 5997
a351880d 5998@node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Remember, Capture - Refile - Archive
864c9740
CD
5999@section Attachments
6000@cindex attachments
6001
c8d0cf5c 6002@vindex org-attach-directory
864c9740
CD
6003It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
6004Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
6005Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can be used to establish associations with
6006files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
6007source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
6008which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
6009uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
6010located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
c8d0cf5c
CD
6011your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
6012directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
864c9740 6013to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
c8d0cf5c 6014@code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
864c9740
CD
6015The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
6016
c8d0cf5c 6017In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
55e0839d
CD
6018choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
6019directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
6020directory.
6021
864c9740
CD
6022@noindent The following commands deal with attachments.
6023
6024@table @kbd
6025
6026@kindex C-c C-a
6027@item C-c C-a
6028The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
6029keys, a list of commands is displayed and you need to press an additional key
6030to select a command:
6031
6032@table @kbd
96c8522a
CD
6033@kindex C-c C-a a
6034@item a
c8d0cf5c 6035@vindex org-attach-method
864c9740
CD
6036Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
6037will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
6038Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6039
6040@kindex C-c C-a c
96c8522a
CD
6041@kindex C-c C-a m
6042@kindex C-c C-a l
864c9740
CD
6043@item c/m/l
6044Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
6045Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6046
6047@kindex C-c C-a n
6048@item n
6049Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
6050
6051@kindex C-c C-a z
6052@item z
6053Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
6054attachments yourself.
6055
6056@kindex C-c C-a o
6057@item o
c8d0cf5c 6058@vindex org-file-apps
864c9740
CD
6059Open current task's attachment. If there are more than one, prompt for a
6060file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
a50253cc 6061For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
864c9740
CD
6062(@pxref{Handling links}).
6063
6064@kindex C-c C-a O
6065@item O
6066Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
6067
6068@kindex C-c C-a f
6069@item f
6070Open the current task's attachment directory.
6071
6072@kindex C-c C-a F
6073@item F
c8d0cf5c 6074Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
864c9740
CD
6075
6076@kindex C-c C-a d
6077@item d
6078Select and delete a single attachment.
6079
6080@kindex C-c C-a D
6081@item D
6082Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
c8d0cf5c 6083@command{dired} and delete from there.
55e0839d
CD
6084
6085@kindex C-c C-a s
6086@item C-c C-a s
c8d0cf5c 6087@cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
55e0839d
CD
6088Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
6089putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
6090
6091@kindex C-c C-a i
6092@item C-c C-a i
c8d0cf5c 6093@cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
55e0839d 6094Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
c8d0cf5c 6095same directory for attachments as the parent does.
864c9740
CD
6096@end table
6097@end table
6098
a351880d 6099@node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
c8d0cf5c
CD
6100@section RSS feeds
6101@cindex RSS feeds
6102
6103Org has the capability to add and change entries based on information found in
6104RSS feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
6105podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
6106web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, you need to configure the
6107variable @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
6108information. Here is just an example:
6109
6110@example
6111(setq org-feed-alist
6112 '(("ReQall" "http://www.reqall.com/user/feeds/rss/a1b2c3....."
6113 "~/org/feeds.org" "ReQall Entries")
6114@end example
6115@noindent
6116will configure that new items from the feed provided by @file{reqall.com}
6117will result in new entries in the file @file{~/org/feeds.org} under the
6118heading @samp{ReQall Entries}, whenever the following command is used:
6119
6120@table @kbd
6121@kindex C-c C-x g
6122@item C-c C-x g
6123Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
6124them.
6125@kindex C-c C-x G
6126@item C-c C-x G
6127Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
6128@end table
6129
6130Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
6131it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
6132adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
6133list of drawers in that file:
6134
6135@example
6136#+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
6137@end example
6138
6139For more information, see @file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of
6140@code{org-feed-alist}.
6141
a351880d 6142@node Protocols, Refiling notes, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
c8d0cf5c
CD
6143@section Protocols for external access
6144@cindex protocols, for external access
6145@cindex emacsserver
6146
6147You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
6148are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
6149configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
6150Org and create a note from it using Remember (@pxref{Remember}). Or you
6151could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
6152a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
6153@uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
6154documentation and setup instructions.
6155
a351880d
CD
6156@node Refiling notes, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
6157@section Refiling notes
6158@cindex refiling notes
c8d0cf5c 6159
a351880d
CD
6160When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile some of the entries
6161into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the
6162right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this
6163process, you can use the following special command:
4009494e 6164
a351880d
CD
6165@table @kbd
6166@kindex C-c C-w
6167@item C-c C-w
6168@vindex org-reverse-note-order
6169@vindex org-refile-targets
6170@vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
6171@vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
6172@vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
6173Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
6174for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
6175all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
6176Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
6177last subitem.@*
6178By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
6179targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
6180See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
6181select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
6182the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
6183@code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
6184create new nodes as new parents for for refiling on the fly, check the
6185variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
6186@kindex C-u C-c C-w
6187@item C-u C-c C-w
6188Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
6189@kindex C-u C-u C-c C-w
6190@item C-u C-u C-c C-w
6191Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
6192@item C-2 C-c C-w
6193Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
6194@end table
4009494e 6195
a351880d
CD
6196@node Archiving, , Refiling notes, Capture - Refile - Archive
6197@section Archiving
6198@cindex archiving
4009494e 6199
a351880d
CD
6200When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
6201to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
6202agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
6203searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
6204
6205@table @kbd
6206@kindex C-c C-x C-a
6207@item C-c C-x C-a
6208@vindex org-archive-default-command
6209Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
6210@code{org-archive-default-command}.
6211@end table
6212
6213@menu
6214* Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
6215* Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep i in the file
6216@end menu
6217
6218@node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
6219@subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
6220@cindex external archiving
6221
6222The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
6223the archive file.
6224
6225@table @kbd
6226@kindex C-c $
6227@kindex C-c C-x C-s
6228@item C-c C-x C-s@ @r{or short} @ C-c $
6229@vindex org-archive-location
6230Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
6231given by @code{org-archive-location}.
6232@kindex C-u C-c C-x C-s
6233@item C-u C-c C-x C-s
6234Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
6235the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
6236If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
6237location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
6238is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
6239@end table
6240
6241@cindex archive locations
6242The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
6243current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
6244current file name. For information and examples on how to change this,
6245see the documentation string of the variable
6246@code{org-archive-location}. There is also an in-buffer option for
6247setting this variable, for example@footnote{For backward compatibility,
6248the following also works: If there are several such lines in a file,
6249each specifies the archive location for the text below it. The first
6250such line also applies to any text before its definition. However,
6251using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible
6252with the outline structure of the document. The correct method for
6253setting multiple archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
6254
6255@cindex #+ARCHIVE
6256@example
6257#+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
6258@end example
6259
6260@cindex property, ARCHIVE
6261@noindent
6262If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
6263or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
6264location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
6265
6266@vindex org-archive-save-context-info
6267When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
6268record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
6269outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
6270@code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
6271added.
6272
6273
6274@node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
6275@subsection Internal archiving
6276
6277If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
6278moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
6279
6280A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
6281its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
6282@itemize @minus
6283@item
6284@vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
6285It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
6286command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
6287subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
6288@code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
6289@code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
6290@item
6291@vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
6292During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
6293archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
6294@code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
6295@item
6296@vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
6297During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
6298archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
6299@code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
6300be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
6301temporarily included.
6302@item
6303@vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
6304Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
6305is. Configure the details using the variable
6306@code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
6307@item
6308@vindex org-columns-skip-arrchived-trees
6309Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
6310@code{org-columns-skip-arrchived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
6311@end itemize
6312
6313The following commands help managing the ARCHIVE tag:
6314
6315@table @kbd
6316@kindex C-c C-x a
6317@item C-c C-x a
6318Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
6319the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
6320hidden.
6321@kindex C-u C-c C-x a
6322@item C-u C-c C-x a
6323Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
6324To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
6325found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
6326cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
6327level 1 trees will be checked.
6328@kindex C-@kbd{TAB}
6329@item C-@kbd{TAB}
6330Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
6331@kindex C-c C-x A
6332@item C-c C-x A
6333Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
6334the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
6335entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
6336original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
6337outline.
6338@end table
6339
6340
6341@node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
6342@chapter Agenda Views
6343@cindex agenda views
6344
6345Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
6346tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
6347files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
6348important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
6349sorted and displayed in an organized way.
6350
6351Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
6352in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
6353
6354@itemize @bullet
6355@item
6356an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
6357for specific dates,
6358@item
6359a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
6360action items,
6361@item
6362a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
6363TODO state associated with them,
6364@item
6365a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
6366in time-sorted view,
6367@item
6368a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
6369that contain specified keywords,
6370@item
6371a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
6372along, and
6373@item
6374@emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
6375views.
4009494e
GM
6376@end itemize
6377
6378@noindent
6379The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
6380buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
a7808fba 6381corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
28a16a1b 6382edit these files remotely.
4009494e 6383
c8d0cf5c
CD
6384@vindex org-agenda-window-setup
6385@vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
4009494e
GM
6386Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
6387window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
6388@code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
6389@code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
6390
6391@menu
6392* Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
6393* Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
6394* Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
6395* Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
a7808fba 6396* Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
4009494e 6397* Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
7006d207 6398* Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
a7808fba 6399* Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
4009494e
GM
6400@end menu
6401
a7808fba 6402@node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
4009494e
GM
6403@section Agenda files
6404@cindex agenda files
6405@cindex files for agenda
6406
c8d0cf5c 6407@vindex org-agenda-files
dbc28aaa
CD
6408The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
6409files}, the files listed in the variable
6410@code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
6411list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
6412maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
6413all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
6414of the list.
6415
c8d0cf5c
CD
6416Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
6417be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
dbc28aaa
CD
6418@kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
6419the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
4009494e
GM
6420dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
6421the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
6422
6423@cindex files, adding to agenda list
6424@table @kbd
6425@kindex C-c [
6426@item C-c [
6427Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
6428the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
a7808fba 6429the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
4009494e
GM
6430@kindex C-c ]
6431@item C-c ]
6432Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
6433@kindex C-,
6434@kindex C-'
6435@item C-,
6436@itemx C-'
6437Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
a7808fba
CD
6438@kindex M-x org-iswitchb
6439@item M-x org-iswitchb
6440Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
6441buffers.
4009494e
GM
6442@end table
6443
6444@noindent
6445The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
6446to visit any of them.
6447
c8d0cf5c
CD
6448If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
6449this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
6450file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
dbc28aaa
CD
6451you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
6452(@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
6453extended period, use the following commands:
6454
6455@table @kbd
6456@kindex C-c C-x <
6457@item C-c C-x <
6458Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
6459prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
6460the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
6461effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
6462or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
6463agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
67df9cfb
CD
6464@kindex C-c C-x >
6465@item C-c C-x >
dbc28aaa
CD
6466Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
6467@end table
6468
6469@noindent
c8d0cf5c 6470When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
a7808fba 6471the Speedbar frame:
dbc28aaa
CD
6472@table @kbd
6473@kindex <
6474@item < @r{in the speedbar frame}
c8d0cf5c
CD
6475Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
6476in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
dbc28aaa
CD
6477If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
6478effect immediately.
67df9cfb 6479@kindex >
dbc28aaa 6480@item > @r{in the speedbar frame}
c8d0cf5c 6481Lift the restriction.
dbc28aaa
CD
6482@end table
6483
a7808fba 6484@node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
4009494e
GM
6485@section The agenda dispatcher
6486@cindex agenda dispatcher
6487@cindex dispatching agenda commands
c8d0cf5c
CD
6488The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
6489global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Installation}). In the
4009494e
GM
6490following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
6491is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
6492pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
6493command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
6494@table @kbd
6495@item a
a7808fba 6496Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
4009494e
GM
6497@item t @r{/} T
6498Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
6499@item m @r{/} M
6500Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
6501tags and properties}).
6502@item L
6503Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
28a16a1b
CD
6504@item s
6505Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
6506and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
dbc28aaa 6507@item /
c8d0cf5c 6508@vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
dbc28aaa 6509Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
c8d0cf5c 6510the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
dbc28aaa
CD
6511uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
6512used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
65131.
28a16a1b
CD
6514@item # @r{/} !
6515Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
dbc28aaa
CD
6516@item <
6517Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
6518compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
6519buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
6520selecting the command.
6521@item < <
4009494e 6522If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
dbc28aaa
CD
6523the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
6524backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
c8d0cf5c 6525current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
dbc28aaa 6526character selecting the command.
4009494e
GM
6527@end table
6528
6529You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
6530dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
6531possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
6532blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
6533a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
6534
a7808fba 6535@node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
4009494e
GM
6536@section The built-in agenda views
6537
6538In this section we describe the built-in views.
6539
6540@menu
a7808fba 6541* Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
4009494e
GM
6542* Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
6543* Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
6544* Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
a351880d 6545* Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
4009494e
GM
6546* Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
6547@end menu
6548
a7808fba 6549@node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
4009494e
GM
6550@subsection The weekly/daily agenda
6551@cindex agenda
6552@cindex weekly agenda
6553@cindex daily agenda
6554
6555The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
6556paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
6557
6558@table @kbd
6559@cindex org-agenda, command
6560@kindex C-c a a
6561@item C-c a a
c8d0cf5c
CD
6562@vindex org-agenda-ndays
6563Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
864c9740
CD
6564shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
6565compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
6566listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
6567list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
6568C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed (see also the
6569variable @code{org-agenda-ndays})
4009494e
GM
6570@end table
6571
6572Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
6573change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
6574The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
6575commands}.
6576
6577@subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
6578@cindex calendar integration
6579@cindex diary integration
6580
6581Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
6582calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
6583countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
6584anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
6585(weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
a7808fba 6586Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
4009494e
GM
6587the diary.
6588
a7808fba 6589In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org mode's
4009494e
GM
6590agenda, you only need to customize the variable
6591
6592@lisp
6593(setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
6594@end lisp
6595
6596@noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
c8d0cf5c 6597entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
a7808fba 6598agenda buffer created by Org mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
4009494e
GM
6599@key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
6600file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
6601insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
6602well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
6603Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
6604calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
6605between calendar and agenda.
6606
6607If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
6608faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
a7808fba 6609the entries into an Org file. Org mode evaluates diary-style sexp
4009494e
GM
6610entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
6611creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
c8d0cf5c 6612the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
a7808fba 6613the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
4009494e
GM
6614will be made in the agenda:
6615
6616@example
6617* Birthdays and similar stuff
6618#+CATEGORY: Holiday
6619%%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
6620#+CATEGORY: Ann
6621%%(diary-anniversary 14 5 1956) Arthur Dent is %d years old
6622%%(diary-anniversary 2 10 1869) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
6623@end example
6624
c8d0cf5c
CD
6625@subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
6626@cindex BBDB, anniversaries
6627@cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
6628
6629If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
6630very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
6631separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
6632anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
6633following to one your your agenda files:
6634
6635@example
6636* Anniversaries
6637 :PROPERTIES:
6638 :CATEGORY: Anniv
6639 :END
6640%%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
6641@end example
6642
6643You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
6644you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
6645record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD}, followed by a
6646space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or @samp{wedding}, or
6647a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to @samp{birthday}.
6648Here are a few examples, the header for the file @file{org-bbdb.el} contains
6649more detailed information.
6650
6651@example
66521973-06-22
66531955-08-02 wedding
66542008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org-mode, %d years ago
6655@end example
6656
6657After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
6658session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
6659hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
6660faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
6661in an Org or Diary file.
6662
dbc28aaa
CD
6663@subsubheading Appointment reminders
6664@cindex @file{appt.el}
6665@cindex appointment reminders
6666
c8d0cf5c
CD
6667Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add all
6668the appointments of your agenda files, use the command
6669@code{org-agenda-to-appt}. This command also lets you filter through the
6670list of your appointments and add only those belonging to a specific category
6671or matching a regular expression. See the docstring for details.
dbc28aaa 6672
a7808fba 6673@node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
4009494e
GM
6674@subsection The global TODO list
6675@cindex global TODO list
6676@cindex TODO list, global
6677
c8d0cf5c 6678The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
4009494e
GM
6679collected into a single place.
6680
6681@table @kbd
6682@kindex C-c a t
6683@item C-c a t
6684Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all
a7808fba 6685agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The buffer is in
4009494e
GM
6686@code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate
6687the TODO entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
6688@kindex C-c a T
6689@item C-c a T
6690@cindex TODO keyword matching
c8d0cf5c 6691@vindex org-todo-keywords
4009494e
GM
6692Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You
6693can also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. With
6694a @kbd{C-u} prefix you are prompted for a keyword, and you may also
c8d0cf5c
CD
6695specify several keywords by separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR
6696operator. With a numeric prefix, the nth keyword in
4009494e
GM
6697@code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
6698@kindex r
6699The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
6700a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
6701for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
6702keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
6703Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
6704search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
6705@end table
6706
6707Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
6708TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
6709TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
6710
a7808fba
CD
6711@cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
6712Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
4009494e
GM
6713keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
6714it more compact:
6715@itemize @minus
6716@item
c8d0cf5c
CD
6717@vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
6718@vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
6719@vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
6720Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
6721have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
6722Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
6723@code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines}, and/or
6724@code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the
6725global TODO list.
6726@item
6727@vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
4009494e
GM
6728TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
6729such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
6730and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
6731@code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
6732@end itemize
6733
6734@node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
a7808fba 6735@subsection Matching tags and properties
4009494e
GM
6736@cindex matching, of tags
6737@cindex matching, of properties
6738@cindex tags view
864c9740 6739@cindex match view
4009494e 6740
c8d0cf5c
CD
6741If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
6742or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
6743based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
6744syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
6745m}.
4009494e
GM
6746
6747@table @kbd
6748@kindex C-c a m
6749@item C-c a m
6750Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
6751command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
dbc28aaa
CD
6752expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
6753@samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
4009494e
GM
6754define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
6755@kindex C-c a M
6756@item C-c a M
c8d0cf5c
CD
6757@vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
6758@vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
6759Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items and
6760force checking subitems (see variable @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
6761To exclude scheduled/deadline items, see the variable
6762@code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching specific TODO
6763keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see @ref{Tag searches}.
4009494e
GM
6764@end table
6765
6766The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
6767commands}.
6768
c8d0cf5c 6769@subsubheading Match syntax
4009494e 6770
c8d0cf5c
CD
6771@cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
6772A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for
6773OR. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently
6774not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
6775expression matching tags, or an expression like @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR
6776VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element
6777may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic
6778sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when
6779@samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
4009494e 6780
c8d0cf5c
CD
6781@table @samp
6782@item +work-boss
6783Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
6784@samp{:boss:}.
6785@item work|laptop
6786Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
6787@item work|laptop+night
6788Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
6789@samp{:night:}.
4009494e
GM
6790@end table
6791
c8d0cf5c
CD
6792@cindex regular expressions, with tags search
6793Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
6794braces. For example,
6795@samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
6796@samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
6797
6798@cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
6799@cindex level, require for tags/property match
6800@cindex category, require for tags/property match
6801@vindex org-odd-levels-only
6802You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
6803time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
6804properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
6805example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
6806entry. Or, the ``property'' @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry.
6807So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines
6808that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword
6809DONE. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not
6810count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
6811
6812Here are more examples:
6813@table @samp
6814@item work+TODO="WAITING"
6815Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
6816keyword @samp{WAITING}.
6817@item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
6818Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
6819@end table
6820
6821When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
6822the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
6823
6824@example
6825+work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
6826 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
6827@end example
6828
6829@noindent
6830The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
6831@itemize @minus
6832@item
6833If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
6834and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
6835@samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
6836@item
6837If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
6838a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
6839@item
6840If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
6841brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
6842assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
6843comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
6844are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
a351880d 6845@code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e. without a time
c8d0cf5c
CD
6846specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
6847@code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
6848respectively, can be used.
6849@item
6850If the comparison value is enclosed
6851in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
6852regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
6853match.
6854@end itemize
6855
6856So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
6857not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
6858@samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
6859property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
6860matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
6861on or after October 11, 2008.
6862
6863Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
6864other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
6865price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
6866again.
6867
6868You can configure Org mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
6869beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
6870inheritance}, for details.
6871
6872For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
6873different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
6874tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
6875connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
6876expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
6877tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive
6878selection on several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with
6879boolean AND. However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be
6880meaningful. To make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any
6881TODO keyword (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently
6882start the TODO part after the slash with @samp{!}. Examples:
6883
6884@table @samp
6885@item work/WAITING
6886Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
6887@item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
6888Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
6889nor @samp{NEXT}
6890@item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
6891Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
6892@samp{NEXT}.
6893@end table
6894
a351880d 6895@node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
c8d0cf5c
CD
6896@subsection Timeline for a single file
6897@cindex timeline, single file
6898@cindex time-sorted view
6899
6900The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org mode
6901file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
6902to give an overview over events in a project.
6903
6904@table @kbd
6905@kindex C-c a L
6906@item C-c a L
6907Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
6908When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
6909(scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
6910@end table
6911
6912@noindent
6913The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
6914@ref{Agenda commands}.
6915
a351880d
CD
6916@node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
6917@subsection Search view
6918@cindex search view
6919@cindex text search
6920@cindex searching, for text
c8d0cf5c
CD
6921
6922This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org mode entries.
6923It is particularly useful to find notes.
28a16a1b
CD
6924
6925@table @kbd
6926@kindex C-c a s
6927@item C-c a s
a351880d
CD
6928This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
6929or specific words using a boolean logic.
6930@end table
6931For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
6932that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
6933separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
6934Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
6935logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
28a16a1b
CD
6936will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
6937and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
6938not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
6939exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g.
6940
c8d0cf5c 6941@vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
28a16a1b
CD
6942Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
6943the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
28a16a1b 6944
a351880d 6945@node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
4009494e
GM
6946@subsection Stuck projects
6947
6948If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
6949work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
6950that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
6951has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
a7808fba 6952Org mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
4009494e
GM
6953projects and define next actions for them.
6954
6955@table @kbd
6956@kindex C-c a #
6957@item C-c a #
6958List projects that are stuck.
6959@kindex C-c a !
6960@item C-c a !
c8d0cf5c 6961@vindex org-stuck-projects
4009494e
GM
6962Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
6963project is and how to find it.
6964@end table
6965
6966You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
6967work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
6968level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
a7808fba 6969one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
4009494e 6970
864c9740 6971Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org mode, identify
a7808fba 6972projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
864c9740 6973indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
a7808fba 6974assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
4009494e
GM
6975and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
6976is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
6977contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
6978either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
c8d0cf5c
CD
6979with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
6980@samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
6981IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
6982correct customization for this is
4009494e
GM
6983
6984@lisp
6985(setq org-stuck-projects
6986 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
6987 "\\<IGNORE\\>"))
6988@end lisp
6989
c8d0cf5c
CD
6990Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
6991will still be searched for stuck projects.
4009494e 6992
a7808fba 6993@node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
4009494e
GM
6994@section Presentation and sorting
6995@cindex presentation, of agenda items
6996
c8d0cf5c 6997@vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
a7808fba 6998Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org mode visually prepares
4009494e
GM
6999the items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line
7000starts with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category}
7001(@pxref{Categories}) of the item and other important information. You can
7002customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
7003The prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
7004associated with the item.
7005
7006@menu
7007* Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
7008* Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
7009* Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
7010@end menu
7011
7012@node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
7013@subsection Categories
7014
7015@cindex category
7016The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
7017the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
dbc28aaa 7018specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
c8d0cf5c 7019backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
dbc28aaa
CD
7020such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
7021The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
7022line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
7023incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
7024method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
7025property.}:
4009494e
GM
7026
7027@example
7028#+CATEGORY: Thesis
7029@end example
7030
dbc28aaa 7031@noindent
c8d0cf5c 7032@cindex property, CATEGORY
dbc28aaa 7033If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
55e0839d
CD
7034(sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
7035special category you want to apply as the value.
dbc28aaa
CD
7036
7037@noindent
7038The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
7039longer than 10 characters.
4009494e
GM
7040
7041@node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
a7808fba 7042@subsection Time-of-day specifications
4009494e
GM
7043@cindex time-of-day specification
7044
a7808fba 7045Org mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
c8d0cf5c 7046time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
4009494e 7047agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
c8d0cf5c 7048ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
4009494e
GM
7049@c
7050@w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
7051
7052In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
44ce9197 7053plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
a7808fba 7054integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
4009494e
GM
7055specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
7056
a7808fba 7057For agenda display, Org mode extracts the time and displays it in a
4009494e
GM
7058standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
7059the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
7060
7061@example
7062 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7063 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7064 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
a50253cc 7065 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
4009494e
GM
7066@end example
7067
7068@cindex time grid
7069If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
7070timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
7071
7072@example
7073 8:00...... ------------------
7074 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7075 10:00...... ------------------
7076 12:00...... ------------------
7077 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7078 14:00...... ------------------
7079 16:00...... ------------------
7080 18:00...... ------------------
7081 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7082 20:00...... ------------------
2096a1b6 7083 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
4009494e
GM
7084@end example
7085
c8d0cf5c
CD
7086@vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7087@vindex org-agenda-time-grid
4009494e
GM
7088The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
7089@code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
7090@code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7091
7092@node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
7093@subsection Sorting of agenda items
7094@cindex sorting, of agenda items
7095@cindex priorities, of agenda items
7096Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
7097done depends on the type of view.
7098@itemize @bullet
7099@item
c8d0cf5c 7100@vindex org-agenda-files
4009494e
GM
7101For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
7102default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
7103time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
7104of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
7105grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
7106Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
7107which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
7108for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
7109overdue scheduled or deadline items.
28a16a1b 7110@item
4009494e
GM
7111For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
7112each category, sorting takes place according to priority
c8d0cf5c
CD
7113(@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
7114priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
7115or scheduled date.
4009494e
GM
7116@item
7117For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
7118sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
7119@end itemize
7120
c8d0cf5c 7121@vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
4009494e 7122Sorting can be customized using the variable
a7808fba 7123@code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
71d35b24 7124the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
4009494e 7125
a7808fba 7126@node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
4009494e
GM
7127@section Commands in the agenda buffer
7128@cindex commands, in agenda buffer
7129
c8d0cf5c 7130Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
4009494e
GM
7131file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
7132buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
c8d0cf5c 7133original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
4009494e
GM
7134the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
7135removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
7136
7137Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
7138the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
7139
7140@table @kbd
7141@tsubheading{Motion}
7142@cindex motion commands in agenda
7143@kindex n
7144@item n
dbc28aaa 7145Next line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
4009494e
GM
7146@kindex p
7147@item p
dbc28aaa 7148Previous line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
c8d0cf5c 7149@tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
4009494e
GM
7150@kindex mouse-3
7151@kindex @key{SPC}
7152@item mouse-3
7153@itemx @key{SPC}
7154Display the original location of the item in another window.
b6cb4cd5
CD
7155With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
7156outline, not only the heading.
4009494e
GM
7157@c
7158@kindex L
7159@item L
7160Display original location and recenter that window.
7161@c
7162@kindex mouse-2
7163@kindex mouse-1
7164@kindex @key{TAB}
7165@item mouse-2
7166@itemx mouse-1
7167@itemx @key{TAB}
7168Go to the original location of the item in another window. Under Emacs
716922, @kbd{mouse-1} will also works for this.
7170@c
7171@kindex @key{RET}
7172@itemx @key{RET}
7173Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
7174@c
6eb02347
CD
7175@kindex F
7176@item F
c8d0cf5c 7177@vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
4009494e
GM
7178Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
7179the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
c8d0cf5c 7180location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
4009494e
GM
7181agenda buffers can be set with the variable
7182@code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
7183@c
6eb02347
CD
7184@kindex C-c C-x b
7185@item C-c C-x b
a7808fba
CD
7186Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
7187numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
7188negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
7189previously used indirect buffer.
6eb02347
CD
7190
7191@kindex C-c C-o
7192@item C-c C-o
7193Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
7194text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
7195will be followed without a selection prompt.
4009494e
GM
7196
7197@tsubheading{Change display}
7198@cindex display changing, in agenda
7199@kindex o
7200@item o
7201Delete other windows.
7202@c
c8d0cf5c 7203@kindex v d
4009494e 7204@kindex d
c8d0cf5c 7205@kindex v w
4009494e 7206@kindex w
c8d0cf5c
CD
7207@kindex v m
7208@kindex v y
7209@item v d @ @r{or short} @ d
7210@itemx v w @ @r{or short} @ w
7211@itemx v m
7212@itemx v y
4009494e 7213Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view,
a7808fba
CD
7214this setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda commands. Since
7215month and year views are slow to create, they do not become the default.
7216A numeric prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day
7217of the year, ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example,
7218@kbd{32 d} jumps to February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When
7219setting day, week, or month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix
7220argument as well. For example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in
72212007. If such a year specification has only one or two digits, it will
7222be mapped to the interval 1938-2037.
4009494e 7223@c
6eb02347
CD
7224@kindex f
7225@item f
7226@vindex org-agenda-ndays
7227Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-ndays} days.
7228For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
7229With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-ndays} days.
7230@c
7231@kindex b
7232@item b
7233Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
7234@c
7235@kindex .
7236@item .
7237Go to today.
7238@c
7239@kindex j
7240@item j
7241Prompt for a date and go there.
7242@c
4009494e
GM
7243@kindex D
7244@item D
a7808fba 7245Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
4009494e 7246@c
6eb02347
CD
7247@kindex v l
7248@kindex l
7249@item v l @ @r{or short} @ l
7250@vindex org-log-done
7251@vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
7252Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
7253logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
7254entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
7255types that should be included in log mode using the variable
7256@code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
7257all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
7258prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
7259@c
7260@kindex v [
7261@kindex [
7262@item v [ @ @r{or short} @ [
7263Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
7264agenda and timeline views.
7265@c
7266@kindex v a
7267@kindex v A
7268@item v a
7269@itemx v A
7270Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
7271@code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
7272capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
7273press @kbd{v a} again.
7274@c
7275@kindex v R
7276@kindex R
7277@item v R @ @r{or short} @ R
7278@vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
7279Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
7280always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
7281covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
7282agenda buffers can be set with the variable
7283@code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}.
7284@c
7285@kindex v E
7286@kindex E
7287@item v E @ @r{or short} @ E
7288@vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
7289@vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
7290Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
7291outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
7292The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
7293@code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
7294prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
7295@c
28a16a1b
CD
7296@kindex G
7297@item G
c8d0cf5c
CD
7298@vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7299@vindex org-agenda-time-grid
4009494e
GM
7300Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
7301@code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7302@c
7303@kindex r
7304@item r
560bb6ea 7305Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
3bcfba17 7306modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
560bb6ea 7307@kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
4009494e
GM
7308argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
7309keyword.
28a16a1b
CD
7310@kindex g
7311@item g
7312Same as @kbd{r}.
4009494e
GM
7313@c
7314@kindex s
dbc28aaa 7315@kindex C-x C-s
4009494e 7316@item s
dbc28aaa 7317@itemx C-x C-s
c8d0cf5c
CD
7318Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
7319IDs.
4009494e 7320@c
a7808fba
CD
7321@kindex C-c C-x C-c
7322@item C-c C-x C-c
c8d0cf5c 7323@vindex org-columns-default-format
a7808fba
CD
7324Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
7325view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
7326point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
7327that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
7328@code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
7329@code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
4009494e 7330
c8d0cf5c
CD
7331@kindex C-c C-x >
7332@item C-c C-x >
7333Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
7334file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
7335
864c9740 7336@tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
71d35b24
CD
7337@cindex filtering, by tag and effort, in agenda
7338@cindex tag filtering, in agenda
7339@cindex effort filtering, in agenda
28a16a1b
CD
7340@cindex query editing, in agenda
7341
864c9740
CD
7342@kindex /
7343@item /
c8d0cf5c 7344@vindex org-agenda-filter-preset
71d35b24 7345Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
c8d0cf5c 7346The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is
71d35b24 7347very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
c8d0cf5c
CD
7348having to recreate the agenda@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
7349binding the variable @code{org-agenda-filter-preset} as an option. This
7350filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
7351refreshes and more secondary filtering.}
71d35b24 7352
a351880d
CD
7353You will be prompted for a tag selection letter, SPC will mean any tag at
7354all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
7355tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
7356then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
7357with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
7358@kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
7359If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
7360will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
7361Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
7362immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
71d35b24 7363
c8d0cf5c 7364@vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
71d35b24
CD
7365In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set-up allowed
7366efforts globally, for example
7367@lisp
7368(setq org-global-properties
7369 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
7370@end lisp
c8d0cf5c
CD
7371You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
7372@kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
7373estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
7374The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
7375or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0-9 are not used
7376as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
7377directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
7378application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
7379according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
7380for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
71d35b24 7381
a351880d
CD
7382Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
7383@code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
7384that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
7385automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
7386as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
7387say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
7388@code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
7389calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
7390Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
7391
7392@lisp
7393@group
7394(defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
7395 (and (cond
7396 ((string= tag "Net")
7397 (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
7398 "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
7399 ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
7400 (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
7401 (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
7402 (concat "-" tag)))
7403
7404(setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
7405@end group
7406@end lisp
7407
71d35b24
CD
7408@kindex \
7409@item \
7410Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
7411prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
7412the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
7413@kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
864c9740 7414
28a16a1b
CD
7415@kindex [
7416@kindex ]
7417@kindex @{
7418@kindex @}
7419@item [ ] @{ @}
6eb02347
CD
7420@table @i
7421@item @r{in} search view
7422add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
7423(@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
7424add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
7425term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
7426negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
864c9740 7427selected.
6eb02347 7428@end table
28a16a1b 7429
a351880d 7430@page
4009494e
GM
7431@tsubheading{Remote editing}
7432@cindex remote editing, from agenda
7433
7434@item 0-9
7435Digit argument.
7436@c
7437@cindex undoing remote-editing events
7438@cindex remote editing, undo
7439@kindex C-_
7440@item C-_
7441Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
7442both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
7443@c
7444@kindex t
7445@item t
7446Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
7447original org file.
7448@c
a351880d
CD
7449@kindex C-S-@key{right}
7450@kindex C-S-@key{left}
7451@item C-S-@key{right}@r{/}@key{left}
7452Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
7453@c
4009494e
GM
7454@kindex C-k
7455@item C-k
c8d0cf5c 7456@vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
4009494e 7457Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
a7808fba 7458to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
4009494e
GM
7459is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
7460variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
7461@c
c8d0cf5c
CD
7462@kindex C-c C-w
7463@item C-c C-w
7464Refile the entry at point.
7465@c
a351880d 7466@kindex C-c C-x C-a
a7808fba 7467@kindex a
a351880d
CD
7468@item C-c C-x C-a @ @r{or short} @ a
7469@vindex org-archive-default-command
7470Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
7471archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
7472@code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
7473@c
7474@kindex C-c C-x a
7475@item C-c C-x a
a7808fba
CD
7476Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
7477@c
a351880d
CD
7478@kindex C-c C-x A
7479@item C-c C-x A
c8d0cf5c
CD
7480Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
7481sibling}.
a7808fba 7482@c
4009494e 7483@kindex $
a351880d
CD
7484@kindex C-c C-x C-s
7485@item C-c C-x C-s @ @r{or short} @ $
a7808fba 7486Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
b349f79f 7487entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
a7808fba 7488different file.
4009494e
GM
7489@c
7490@kindex T
7491@item T
c8d0cf5c 7492@vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
96c8522a
CD
7493Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
7494turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
7495tags of a headline occasionally.
4009494e
GM
7496@c
7497@kindex :
7498@item :
dbc28aaa
CD
7499Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
7500agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
4009494e 7501@c
4009494e
GM
7502@kindex ,
7503@item ,
a7808fba 7504Set the priority for the current item. Org mode prompts for the
4009494e
GM
7505priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC}, the priority cookie
7506is removed from the entry.
7507@c
7508@kindex P
7509@item P
7510Display weighted priority of current item.
7511@c
7512@kindex +
7513@kindex S-@key{up}
7514@item +
7515@itemx S-@key{up}
7516Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
7517the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
7518key for this.
7519@c
7520@kindex -
7521@kindex S-@key{down}
7522@item -
7523@itemx S-@key{down}
7524Decrease the priority of the current item.
7525@c
c8d0cf5c
CD
7526@kindex z
7527@item z
7528@vindex org-log-into-drawer
7529Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then files to the
7530same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
7531@code{org-log-into-drawer}, this maybe inside a drawer.
7532@c
864c9740
CD
7533@kindex C-c C-a
7534@item C-c C-a
7535Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
7536@c
4009494e
GM
7537@kindex C-c C-s
7538@item C-c C-s
7539Schedule this item
7540@c
7541@kindex C-c C-d
7542@item C-c C-d
7543Set a deadline for this item.
7544@c
b349f79f
CD
7545@kindex k
7546@item k
7547Agenda actions, to set dates for selected items to the cursor date.
7548This command also works in the calendar! The command prompts for an
a50253cc 7549additional key:
b349f79f
CD
7550@example
7551m @r{Mark the entry at point for action. You can also make entries}
7552 @r{in Org files with @kbd{C-c C-x C-k}.}
7553d @r{Set the deadline of the marked entry to the date at point.}
7554s @r{Schedule the marked entry at the date at point.}
7555r @r{Call @code{org-remember} with the cursor date as default date.}
7556@end example
c8d0cf5c 7557@noindent
a50253cc 7558Press @kbd{r} afterward to refresh the agenda and see the effect of the
b349f79f
CD
7559command.
7560@c
4009494e
GM
7561@kindex S-@key{right}
7562@item S-@key{right}
c8d0cf5c 7563Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
a7808fba 7564future. With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For
c8d0cf5c
CD
7565example, @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a
7566@kbd{C-u} prefix, change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the
7567command, it will continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With
7568a double @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes. The stamp
7569is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly reflected
7570in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
4009494e
GM
7571@c
7572@kindex S-@key{left}
7573@item S-@key{left}
c8d0cf5c 7574Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
4009494e
GM
7575into the past.
7576@c
7577@kindex >
7578@item >
c8d0cf5c 7579Change the timestamp associated with the current line to today.
4009494e
GM
7580The key @kbd{>} has been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.}
7581on my keyboard.
7582@c
7583@kindex I
7584@item I
7585Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
7586is stopped first.
7587@c
7588@kindex O
7589@item O
7590Stop the previously started clock.
7591@c
7592@kindex X
7593@item X
7594Cancel the currently running clock.
7595
dbc28aaa
CD
7596@kindex J
7597@item J
7598Jump to the running clock in another window.
7599
c8d0cf5c
CD
7600@tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
7601@cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
7602
7603@kindex m
7604@item s
7605Mark the entry at point for bulk action.
7606
7607@kindex u
7608@item u
7609Unmark entry for bulk action.
7610
7611@kindex U
7612@item U
7613Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
7614
7615@kindex B
7616@item B
7617Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
7618another key to select the action to be applied:
7619@example
7620r @r{Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries}
7621 @r{will no longer be in the agenda, refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.}
7622$ @r{Archive all selected entries.}
7623A @r{Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.}
7624t @r{Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and}
7625 @r{changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and}
7626 @r{suppressing logging notes (but not time stamps).}
7627+ @r{Add a tag to all selected entries.}
7628- @r{Remove a tag from all selected entries.}
7629s @r{Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates}
7630 @r{by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus}
7631 @r{at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.}
7632d @r{Set deadline to a specific date.}
7633@end example
7634
7635
4009494e
GM
7636@tsubheading{Calendar commands}
7637@cindex calendar commands, from agenda
7638@kindex c
7639@item c
7640Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
7641@c
7642@item c
a7808fba 7643When in the calendar, compute and show the Org mode agenda for the
4009494e
GM
7644date at the cursor.
7645@c
7646@cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
7647@kindex i
7648@item i
a351880d
CD
7649@vindex org-agenda-diary-file
7650Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
7651block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
7652file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
7653@code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
7654command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
7655you can add the entry.
7656
7657If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org-mode file,
7658Org will create entries (in org-mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
7659entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
7660easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
7661build under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
7662top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text - if you specify
7663it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
7664interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
7665text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
7666entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
4009494e
GM
7667@c
7668@kindex M
7669@item M
7670Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
7671@c
7672@kindex S
7673@item S
7674Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
c8d0cf5c 7675with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
4009494e
GM
7676@c
7677@kindex C
7678@item C
7679Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
7680calendars.
7681@c
7682@kindex H
7683@item H
c8d0cf5c 7684Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
a7808fba
CD
7685
7686@item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
4009494e 7687Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
a7808fba 7688This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
4009494e
GM
7689
7690@tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
7691@kindex C-x C-w
7692@item C-x C-w
7693@cindex exporting agenda views
7694@cindex agenda views, exporting
c8d0cf5c
CD
7695@vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
7696Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
7697file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
7698@file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), PDF (extension @file{.pdf}),
a351880d
CD
7699and plain text (any other extension). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix
7700argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable
7701@code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
7702for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
4009494e
GM
7703
7704@tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
7705@kindex q
7706@item q
7707Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
7708@c
7709@kindex x
7710@cindex agenda files, removing buffers
7711@item x
7712Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
7713for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
c8d0cf5c 7714visit Org files will not be removed.
4009494e
GM
7715@end table
7716
7717
c8d0cf5c 7718@node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
4009494e
GM
7719@section Custom agenda views
7720@cindex custom agenda views
7721@cindex agenda views, custom
7722
7723Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
7724frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
7725agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
7726dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
7727
7728@menu
7729* Storing searches:: Type once, use often
7730* Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
7731* Setting Options:: Changing the rules
4009494e
GM
7732@end menu
7733
7734@node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
7735@subsection Storing searches
7736
7737The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
7738shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
7739buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
7740buffer).
7741@kindex C-c a C
c8d0cf5c 7742@vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
4009494e
GM
7743Custom commands are configured in the variable
7744@code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
7745example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with
7746Emacs Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid
7747search types:
7748
7749@lisp
7750@group
7751(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
7752 '(("w" todo "WAITING")
7753 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
dbc28aaa
CD
7754 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
7755 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
7756 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
7757 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
7758 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
7759 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
7760 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
7761 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
4009494e
GM
7762@end group
7763@end lisp
7764
7765@noindent
dbc28aaa
CD
7766The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
7767after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
7768Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
7769similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
7770first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
7771prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
7772inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
7773parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
7774expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
7775therefore define:
4009494e
GM
7776
7777@table @kbd
7778@item C-c a w
7779as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
7780keyword
7781@item C-c a W
7782as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
7783results as a sparse tree
7784@item C-c a u
dbc28aaa
CD
7785as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
7786@samp{:urgent:}
4009494e
GM
7787@item C-c a v
7788as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
7789headlines that are also TODO items
7790@item C-c a U
7791as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
7792displaying the result as a sparse tree
7793@item C-c a f
7794to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
dbc28aaa
CD
7795containing the word @samp{FIXME}
7796@item C-c a h
7797as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
7798additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
7799Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
4009494e
GM
7800@end table
7801
7802@node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
7803@subsection Block agenda
7804@cindex block agenda
7805@cindex agenda, with block views
7806
7807Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
7808the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
7809the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
7810daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
a7808fba 7811for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
4009494e
GM
7812matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
7813@code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
7814
7815@lisp
7816@group
7817(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
7818 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
28a16a1b 7819 ((agenda "")
dbc28aaa
CD
7820 (tags-todo "home")
7821 (tags "garden")))
4009494e 7822 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
28a16a1b 7823 ((agenda "")
dbc28aaa
CD
7824 (tags-todo "work")
7825 (tags "office")))))
4009494e
GM
7826@end group
7827@end lisp
7828
7829@noindent
7830This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
7831you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
7832your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
dbc28aaa 7833@samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
4009494e
GM
7834command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
7835
c8d0cf5c 7836@node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
a7808fba 7837@subsection Setting options for custom commands
4009494e
GM
7838@cindex options, for custom agenda views
7839
c8d0cf5c 7840@vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
a7808fba 7841Org mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
4009494e
GM
7842and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
7843commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
7844some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
7845options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
7846right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
7847
7848@lisp
7849@group
7850(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
7851 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
7852 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
7853 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
dbc28aaa 7854 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
4009494e 7855 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
28a16a1b
CD
7856 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
7857 ("N" search ""
7858 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
7859 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
4009494e
GM
7860@end group
7861@end lisp
7862
7863@noindent
7864Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
dbc28aaa 7865priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
4009494e
GM
7866instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
7867@kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
7868headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
28a16a1b
CD
7869will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
7870to only a single file.
4009494e 7871
c8d0cf5c 7872@vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
4009494e
GM
7873For command sets creating a block agenda,
7874@code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
7875options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
7876command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
7877the set. The former are just added to the command entry, the latter
7878must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
7879agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
7880for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
7881the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
7882@code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
7883
7884@lisp
7885@group
7886(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
7887 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
7888 ((agenda)
dbc28aaa
CD
7889 (tags-todo "home")
7890 (tags "garden"
4009494e
GM
7891 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
7892 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
7893 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
7894 ((agenda)
dbc28aaa
CD
7895 (tags-todo "work")
7896 (tags "office")))))
4009494e
GM
7897@end group
7898@end lisp
7899
c8d0cf5c
CD
7900As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
7901When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
7902fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
7903this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
7904value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
4009494e
GM
7905yourself.
7906
7907
c8d0cf5c
CD
7908@node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
7909@section Exporting Agenda Views
4009494e
GM
7910@cindex agenda views, exporting
7911
3da3282e
CD
7912If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
7913version of some agenda views to carry around. Org mode can export custom
7914agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
c8d0cf5c
CD
7915@file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
7916ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
7917a PDF file with also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
7918you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
4009494e
GM
7919
7920@table @kbd
7921@kindex C-x C-w
7922@item C-x C-w
7923@cindex exporting agenda views
7924@cindex agenda views, exporting
c8d0cf5c 7925@vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
7006d207
CD
7926Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
7927file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
7928@file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
a351880d
CD
7929@file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
7930@code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
7931for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
28a16a1b 7932
c8d0cf5c
CD
7933@vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
7934@vindex htmlize-output-type
7935@vindex ps-number-of-columns
7936@vindex ps-landscape-mode
4009494e
GM
7937@lisp
7938(setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
7939 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
7940 (ps-landscape-mode t)
c8d0cf5c 7941 (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
4009494e
GM
7942 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
7943@end lisp
7944@end table
7945
7946If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
7947any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
7948@footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
7949or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
28a16a1b 7950them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
c8d0cf5c
CD
7951that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
7952TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
28a16a1b 7953Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
4009494e
GM
7954as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
7955or absolute.
7956
7957@lisp
7958@group
7959(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
7960 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
7961 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
7962 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
28a16a1b 7963 ((agenda "")
dbc28aaa
CD
7964 (tags-todo "home")
7965 (tags "garden"))
4009494e
GM
7966 nil
7967 ("~/views/home.html"))
7968 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
7969 ((agenda)
dbc28aaa
CD
7970 (tags-todo "work")
7971 (tags "office"))
4009494e 7972 nil
28a16a1b 7973 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
4009494e
GM
7974@end group
7975@end lisp
7976
7977The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
a7808fba 7978@file{.html}, Org mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
4009494e
GM
7979the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
7980@file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
c8d0cf5c 7981Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
28a16a1b 7982run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
c8d0cf5c 7983limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
28a16a1b 7984extension produces a plain ASCII file.
4009494e
GM
7985
7986The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
28a16a1b
CD
7987commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
7988Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
7989files in one step:
4009494e
GM
7990
7991@table @kbd
7992@kindex C-c a e
7993@item C-c a e
28a16a1b 7994Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
4009494e
GM
7995them.
7996@end table
7997
7998You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
7999set options for the export commands. For example:
8000
8001@lisp
8002(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8003 '(("X" agenda ""
8004 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8005 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8006 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
8007 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
8008 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
8009 ("theagenda.ps"))))
8010@end lisp
8011
8012@noindent
c8d0cf5c
CD
8013This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
8014print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
4009494e
GM
8015in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
8016the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
8017instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
8018to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
8019black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
8020@code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
8021in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
8022
8023@noindent
8024From the command line you may also use
8025@example
8026emacs -f org-batch-store-agenda-views -kill
8027@end example
8028@noindent
c8d0cf5c
CD
8029or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
8030system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
4009494e
GM
8031@example
8032emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
8033 org-agenda-ndays 30 \
dbc28aaa 8034 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
4009494e
GM
8035 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
8036 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
8037 -kill
8038@end example
8039@noindent
8040which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
c8d0cf5c 8041@file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
28a16a1b 8042extent.
4009494e 8043
c8d0cf5c
CD
8044You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
8045processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
8046more information.
4009494e 8047
4009494e 8048
c8d0cf5c 8049@node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
a7808fba
CD
8050@section Using column view in the agenda
8051@cindex column view, in agenda
8052@cindex agenda, column view
8053
8054Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
8055properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
8056quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
8057collected by certain criteria.
8058
8059@table @kbd
8060@kindex C-c C-x C-c
8061@item C-c C-x C-c
8062Turn on column view in the agenda.
8063@end table
8064
8065To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
8066entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
8067This causes the following issues:
8068
8069@enumerate
8070@item
c8d0cf5c
CD
8071@vindex org-columns-default-format
8072@vindex org-overriding-columns-format
a7808fba
CD
8073Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
8074entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
8075may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
8076Org first checks if the variable @code{org-overriding-columns-format} is
c8d0cf5c 8077currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
a7808fba 8078the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
c8d0cf5c 8079does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
a7808fba
CD
8080uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
8081@item
c8d0cf5c 8082@cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
a7808fba
CD
8083If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
8084turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
8085make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
8086also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
8087values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
8088cover a single day, in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
8089vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
8090example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
c8d0cf5c 8091same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
a7808fba
CD
8092cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
8093some values will count double.
8094@item
8095When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
8096the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
8097the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
8098current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
c8d0cf5c 8099a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
a7808fba
CD
8100applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
8101clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
8102the agenda).
8103@end enumerate
8104
8105
a351880d
CD
8106@node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
8107@chapter Markup for rich export
4009494e 8108
a351880d
CD
8109When exporting Org-mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
8110structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend. Since
8111export targets like HTML, La@TeX{}, or DocBook allow much richer formatting,
8112Org mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section
8113summarizes the markup rules used in an Org-mode buffer.
4009494e 8114
a351880d
CD
8115@menu
8116* Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
8117* Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
8118* Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
8119* Include files:: Include additional files into a document
8120* Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
8121* Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
8122@end menu
8123
8124@node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
8125@section Structural markup elements
4009494e
GM
8126
8127@menu
a351880d
CD
8128* Document title:: Where the title is taken from
8129* Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
8130* Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
8131* Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
8132* Lists:: Lists
8133* Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
8134* Footnote markup:: Footnotes
8135* Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
8136* Horizontal rules:: Make a line
8137* Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
4009494e
GM
8138@end menu
8139
a351880d
CD
8140@node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
8141@subheading Document title
8142@cindex document title, markup rules
4009494e 8143
a351880d
CD
8144@noindent
8145The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
4009494e 8146
a351880d 8147@cindex #+TITLE
4009494e 8148@example
a351880d 8149#+TITLE: This is the title of the document
4009494e 8150@end example
a351880d 8151
c8d0cf5c 8152@noindent
a351880d
CD
8153If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
8154non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
8155turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
8156title will be the file name without extension.
4009494e 8157
a351880d
CD
8158@cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
8159If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
8160of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
8161property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
4009494e 8162
a351880d
CD
8163@node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
8164@subheading Headings and sections
8165@cindex headings and sections, markup rules
8166
8167@vindex org-export-headline-levels
8168The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
8169Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
8170However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
8171tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
8172levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
8173switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
8174per-file basis with a line
4009494e 8175
a351880d 8176@cindex #+OPTIONS
4009494e 8177@example
a351880d 8178#+OPTIONS: H:4
4009494e
GM
8179@end example
8180
a351880d
CD
8181@node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
8182@subheading Table of contents
8183@cindex table of contents, markup rules
4009494e 8184
a351880d
CD
8185@vindex org-export-with-toc
8186The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
8187of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
8188string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
8189location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
8190number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off
8191the table of contents entirely, by configuring the variable
8192@code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
b349f79f
CD
8193
8194@example
8195#+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
8196#+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
8197@end example
8198
a351880d 8199@node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
b349f79f
CD
8200@subheading Text before the first headline
8201@cindex text before first headline, markup rules
8202@cindex #+TEXT
8203
8204Org mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
8205the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
c8d0cf5c
CD
8206you need to include literal HTML, La@TeX{}, or DocBook code, use the special
8207constructs described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
b349f79f 8208
c8d0cf5c 8209@vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
b349f79f
CD
8210Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
8211internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
8212the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
8213@code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
8214basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
8215
8216@noindent
8217If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
8218@code{#+TEXT} construct:
8219
8220@example
8221#+OPTIONS: skip:t
8222#+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
8223#+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
8224#+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the first headline
8225@end example
8226
a351880d 8227@node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Structural markup elements
b349f79f
CD
8228@subheading Lists
8229@cindex lists, markup rules
8230
c8d0cf5c
CD
8231Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the backend's
8232syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered, ordered, and
b349f79f
CD
8233description lists.
8234
a351880d 8235@node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
b349f79f
CD
8236@subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
8237@cindex paragraphs, markup rules
8238
8239Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
8240a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
8241
8242To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
8243can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
8244
c8d0cf5c 8245@cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
b349f79f
CD
8246@example
8247#+BEGIN_VERSE
864c9740
CD
8248 Great clouds overhead
8249 Tiny black birds rise and fall
8250 Snow covers Emacs
96c8522a 8251
864c9740 8252 -- AlexSchroeder
b349f79f
CD
8253#+END_VERSE
8254@end example
8255
8256When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
8257as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
c8d0cf5c 8258can include quotations in Org-mode documents like this:
b349f79f 8259
c8d0cf5c 8260@cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
b349f79f
CD
8261@example
8262#+BEGIN_QUOTE
8263Everything should be made as simple as possible,
8264but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
8265#+END_QUOTE
8266@end example
8267
c8d0cf5c
CD
8268If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
8269@cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
8270@example
8271#+BEGIN_CENTER
8272Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
8273but not any simpler
8274#+END_CENTER
8275@end example
b349f79f 8276
a351880d
CD
8277
8278@node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
8279@subheading Footnote markup
8280@cindex footnotes, markup rules
8281@cindex @file{footnote.el}
8282
8283Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported by
8284all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
8285different backends support this to varying degrees.
8286
8287@node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
8288@subheading Emphasis and monospace
8289
8290@cindex underlined text, markup rules
8291@cindex bold text, markup rules
8292@cindex italic text, markup rules
8293@cindex verbatim text, markup rules
8294@cindex code text, markup rules
8295@cindex strike-through text, markup rules
8296You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
8297and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
8298in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org-mode specific
8299syntax, it is exported verbatim.
8300
8301@node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
8302@subheading Horizontal rules
8303@cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
8304A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be
8305exported as a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML).
8306
8307@node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
8308@subheading Comment lines
8309@cindex comment lines
8310@cindex exporting, not
8311@cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
8312
8313Lines starting with @samp{#} in column zero are treated as comments and will
8314never be exported. If you want an indented line to be treated as a comment,
8315start it with @samp{#+ }. Also entire subtrees starting with the word
8316@samp{COMMENT} will never be exported. Finally, regions surrounded by
8317@samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT} ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
8318
8319@table @kbd
8320@kindex C-c ;
8321@item C-c ;
8322Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
8323@end table
8324
8325
8326@node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
8327@section Images and Tables
8328
8329@cindex tables, markup rules
8330@cindex #+CAPTION
8331@cindex #+LABEL
8332Both the native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
8333the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org mode tables,
8334the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
8335lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
8336a caption and a label for cross references:
8337
8338@example
8339#+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
8340#+LABEL: tbl:basic-data
8341 | ... | ...|
8342 |-----|----|
8343@end example
8344
8345@cindex inlined images, markup rules
8346Some backends (HTML, La@TeX{}, and DocBook) allow you to directly include
8347images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image
8348files does not have a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}.
8349If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal
8350cross references, you sure that the link is on a line by itself precede it
8351with:
8352
8353@example
8354#+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
8355#+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
8356[[./img/a.jpg]]
8357@end example
8358
8359You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
8360backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
8361information.
8362
8363
8364@node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
8365@section Literal examples
b349f79f 8366@cindex literal examples, markup rules
c8d0cf5c 8367@cindex code line references, markup rules
b349f79f
CD
8368
8369You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
8370markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
8371for source code and similar examples.
8372@cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
8373
8374@example
8375#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
8376Some example from a text file.
8377#+END_EXAMPLE
8378@end example
8379
c8d0cf5c
CD
8380Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
8381indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
8382lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
8383example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
55e0839d 8384whitespace before the colon:
b349f79f
CD
8385
8386@example
55e0839d
CD
8387Here is an example
8388 : Some example from a text file.
b349f79f
CD
8389@end example
8390
8391@cindex formatting source code, markup rules
8392If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
8393that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
6eb02347
CD
8394look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{Currently this works for the
8395HTML backend, and requires the @file{htmlize.el} package version 1.34 or
8396later. It also works for LaTeX with the listings package, if you turn on the
8397option @code{org-export-latex-listings} and make sure that the listings
8398package is included by the LaTeX header.}. This is done with the @samp{src}
8399block, where you also need to specify the name of the major mode that should
8400be used to fontify the example:
b349f79f
CD
8401@cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
8402
8403@example
8404#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
8405(defun org-xor (a b)
8406 "Exclusive or."
8407 (if a (not b) b))
8408#+END_SRC
8409@end example
8410
55e0839d
CD
8411Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
8412switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
8413numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
8414numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
8415Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
a351880d 8416targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e. the reference name
c8d0cf5c
CD
8417enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
8418link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
8419cool.
8420
8421You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
8422source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
8423labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
8424be useful to explain those in an org-mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
8425switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
8426the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
8427Here is an example:
55e0839d
CD
8428
8429@example
8430#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
8431(save-excursion (ref:sc)
8432 (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
c8d0cf5c
CD
8433#+END_SRC
8434In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
55e0839d
CD
8435jumps to point-min.
8436@end example
8437
c8d0cf5c 8438@vindex org-coderef-label-format
55e0839d
CD
8439If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
8440@code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
8441-n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
8442
c8d0cf5c 8443HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas, @xref{Text
2096a1b6 8444areas in HTML export}.
55e0839d 8445
b349f79f
CD
8446@table @kbd
8447@kindex C-c '
8448@item C-c '
8449Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
c8d0cf5c
CD
8450switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
8451pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*}
8452or @samp{#} will get a comma prepended, to keep them from being interpreted
8453by Org as outline nodes or special comments. These commas will be striped
8454for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}, the edited version will
8455then replace the old version in the Org buffer. Fixed-width regions
8456(where each line starts with a colon followed by a space) will be edited
8457using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select a different-mode with the
8458variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.} to allow creating ASCII
8459drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line will create a new
864c9740 8460fixed-width region.
55e0839d
CD
8461@kindex C-c l
8462@item C-c l
8463Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
8464temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label, make sure
8465that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
8466formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
8467label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
b349f79f
CD
8468@end table
8469
8470
a351880d
CD
8471@node Include files, Macro replacement, Literal examples, Markup
8472@section Include files
b349f79f
CD
8473@cindex include files, markup rules
8474
8475During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
c8d0cf5c 8476include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
b349f79f
CD
8477@cindex #+INCLUDE
8478
8479@example
8480#+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
8481@end example
c8d0cf5c 8482@noindent
6eb02347 8483The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g. @samp{quote},
b349f79f
CD
8484@samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
8485language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional, if it is not
8486given, the text will be assumed to be in Org mode format and will be
44ce9197
CD
8487processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
8488parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
55e0839d
CD
8489first line and for each following line, as well as any options accepted by
8490the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item, use
44ce9197
CD
8491
8492@example
8493#+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
8494@end example
b349f79f
CD
8495
8496@table @kbd
8497@kindex C-c '
8498@item C-c '
8499Visit the include file at point.
8500@end table
8501
b349f79f 8502
a351880d
CD
8503@node Macro replacement, Embedded LaTeX, Include files, Markup
8504@section Macro replacement
8505@cindex macro replacement, during export
8506@cindex #+MACRO
8507
8508You can define text snippets with
8509
8510@example
8511#+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
8512@end example
8513
8514@noindent which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in
8515code examples) with @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}. In addition to
8516defined macros, @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc.,
8517will reference information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and
8518similar lines. Also, @code{@{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
8519@code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
8520and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
8521@var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
8522@code{format-time-string}.
8523
8524Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
8525construct complex HTML code.
8526
8527
8528@node Embedded LaTeX, , Macro replacement, Markup
8529@section Embedded La@TeX{}
8530@cindex @TeX{} interpretation
8531@cindex La@TeX{} interpretation
8532
8533Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. One
8534exception, however, are scientific notes which need to be able to contain
8535mathematical symbols and the occasional formula. La@TeX{}@footnote{La@TeX{}
8536is a macro system based on Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the
8537features described here as ``La@TeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for
8538simplicity I am blurring this distinction.} is widely used to typeset
8539scientific documents. Org mode supports embedding La@TeX{} code into its
8540files, because many academics are used to reading La@TeX{} source code, and
8541because it can be readily processed into images for HTML production.
8542
8543It is not necessary to mark La@TeX{} macros and code in any special way.
8544If you observe a few conventions, Org mode knows how to find it and what
8545to do with it.
8546
8547@menu
8548* Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
8549* Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
8550* LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
8551* Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
8552* CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
8553@end menu
8554
8555@node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX, Embedded LaTeX
8556@subsection Special symbols
8557@cindex math symbols
8558@cindex special symbols
8559@cindex @TeX{} macros
8560@cindex La@TeX{} fragments, markup rules
8561@cindex HTML entities
8562@cindex La@TeX{} entities
8563
8564You can use La@TeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
8565indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
8566for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
8567and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike La@TeX{}
8568code, Org mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
8569delimiters, for example:
8570
8571@example
8572Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
8573@end example
8574
8575@vindex org-html-entities
8576During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
8577the exporter backend. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
8578@code{&alpha;} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the La@TeX{}
8579output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{&nbsp;} in HTML and
8580@code{~} in La@TeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
8581like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
8582
8583A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
8584La@TeX{}, see the variable @code{org-html-entities} for the complete list.
8585@samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
8586@samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
8587different lengths or a compact set of dots.
8588
8589@node Subscripts and superscripts, LaTeX fragments, Special symbols, Embedded LaTeX
8590@subsection Subscripts and superscripts
8591@cindex subscript
8592@cindex superscript
8593
8594Just like in La@TeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
8595and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
8596math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
8597not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
8598with curly braces. For example
67df9cfb
CD
8599
8600@example
a351880d
CD
8601The mass if the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
8602the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
67df9cfb
CD
8603@end example
8604
a351880d
CD
8605@vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
8606To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote @samp{^} and
8607@samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\^} and @samp{\_}. If you write a text
8608where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention
8609to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
8610variable @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} to globally change this
8611convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
67df9cfb
CD
8612
8613@example
a351880d 8614#+OPTIONS: ^:@{@}
67df9cfb 8615@end example
b349f79f 8616
67df9cfb 8617
a351880d
CD
8618@node LaTeX fragments, Previewing LaTeX fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX
8619@subsection La@TeX{} fragments
8620@cindex La@TeX{} fragments
b349f79f 8621
a351880d
CD
8622@vindex org-format-latex-header
8623With symbols, sub- and superscripts, HTML is pretty much at its end when
8624it comes to representing mathematical formulas@footnote{Yes, there is
8625MathML, but that is not yet fully supported by many browsers, and there
8626is no decent converter for turning La@TeX{} or ASCII representations of
8627formulas into MathML. So for the time being, converting formulas into
8628images seems the way to go.}. More complex expressions need a dedicated
8629formula processor. To this end, Org mode can contain arbitrary La@TeX{}
8630fragments. It provides commands to preview the typeset result of these
8631fragments, and upon export to HTML, all fragments will be converted to
8632images and inlined into the HTML document@footnote{The La@TeX{} export
8633will not use images for displaying La@TeX{} fragments but include these
8634fragments directly into the La@TeX{} code.}. For this to work you
8635need to be on a system with a working La@TeX{} installation. You also
8636need the @file{dvipng} program, available at
8637@url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/}. The La@TeX{} header that
8638will be used when processing a fragment can be configured with the
8639variable @code{org-format-latex-header}.
b349f79f 8640
a351880d
CD
8641La@TeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
8642snippets will be identified as La@TeX{} source code:
8643@itemize @bullet
8644@item
8645Environments of any kind. The only requirement is that the
8646@code{\begin} statement appears on a new line, preceded by only
8647whitespace.
8648@item
8649Text within the usual La@TeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
8650currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
8651math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
8652directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
8653and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
8654For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
8655@samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
8656@end itemize
b349f79f 8657
a351880d 8658@noindent For example:
b349f79f 8659
a351880d
CD
8660@example
8661\begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
8662x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
8663\end@{equation@} % etc
b349f79f 8664
a351880d
CD
8665If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
8666either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
8667@end example
b349f79f 8668
a351880d
CD
8669@noindent
8670@vindex org-format-latex-options
8671If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
8672can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
8673ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the La@TeX{} converter.
b349f79f 8674
a351880d
CD
8675@node Previewing LaTeX fragments, CDLaTeX mode, LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
8676@subsection Previewing LaTeX fragments
8677@cindex LaTeX fragments, preview
b349f79f 8678
a351880d
CD
8679La@TeX{} fragments can be processed to produce preview images of the
8680typeset expressions:
b349f79f
CD
8681
8682@table @kbd
a351880d
CD
8683@kindex C-c C-x C-l
8684@item C-c C-x C-l
8685Produce a preview image of the La@TeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
8686over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
8687fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
8688with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
8689two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
8690process the entire buffer.
8691@kindex C-c C-c
8692@item C-c C-c
8693Remove the overlay preview images.
b349f79f
CD
8694@end table
8695
a351880d
CD
8696@vindex org-format-latex-options
8697You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
8698some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
8699export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
8700preview images.
c8d0cf5c 8701
a351880d
CD
8702During HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), all La@TeX{} fragments are
8703converted into images and inlined into the document if the following
8704setting is active:
c8d0cf5c 8705
a351880d
CD
8706@lisp
8707(setq org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments t)
8708@end lisp
c8d0cf5c 8709
a351880d
CD
8710@node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
8711@subsection Using CDLa@TeX{} to enter math
8712@cindex CDLa@TeX{}
8713
8714CDLa@TeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
8715major La@TeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
8716environments and math templates. Inside Org mode, you can make use of
8717some of the features of CDLa@TeX{} mode. You need to install
8718@file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
8719AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
8720Don't use CDLa@TeX{} mode itself under Org mode, but use the light
8721version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org mode. Turn it
8722on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
8723Org files with
8724
8725@lisp
8726(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
8727@end lisp
8728
8729When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
8730details see the documentation of CDLa@TeX{} mode):
8731@itemize @bullet
8732@kindex C-c @{
8733@item
8734Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
8735@item
8736@kindex @key{TAB}
8737The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
8738La@TeX{} fragment@footnote{Org mode has a method to test if the cursor is
8739inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
8740@code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
8741expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
8742correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
8743the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
8744environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
8745you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
8746this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
8747To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
8748@item
8749@kindex _
8750@kindex ^
8751@vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
8752Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a La@TeX{} fragment will insert these
8753characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
8754out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
8755macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
8756@code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
8757@item
8758@kindex `
8759Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
8760macros, also outside La@TeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
8761after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
8762@item
8763@kindex '
8764Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
8765the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
87661.5 seconds after the backquote, a help window will pop up. Character
8767modification will work only inside La@TeX{} fragments, outside the quote
8768is normal.
8769@end itemize
8770
8771@node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
8772@chapter Exporting
8773@cindex exporting
8774
8775Org-mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
8776printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and simple
8777version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a notes file on
8778the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for exchange with a
8779broad range of other applications. La@TeX{} export lets you use Org mode and
8780its structured editing functions to easily create La@TeX{} files. DocBook
8781export makes it possible to convert Org files to many other formats using
8782DocBook tools. To incorporate entries with associated times like deadlines
8783or appointments into a desktop calendar program like iCal, Org mode can also
8784produce extracts in the iCalendar format. Currently Org mode only supports
8785export, not import of these different formats.
8786
8787Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
8788enabled (default in Emacs 23).
8789
8790@menu
8791* Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
8792* Export options:: Per-file export settings
8793* The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
8794* ASCII export:: Exporting to plain ASCII
8795* HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
8796* LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to La@TeX{}, and processing to PDF
8797* DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
8798* Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
8799* XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
8800* iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
8801@end menu
c8d0cf5c 8802
a351880d 8803@node Selective export, Export options, Exporting, Exporting
864c9740
CD
8804@section Selective export
8805@cindex export, selective by tags
8806
c8d0cf5c
CD
8807@vindex org-export-select-tags
8808@vindex org-export-exclude-tags
864c9740
CD
8809You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
8810or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
8811@code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags}.
8812
8813Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the buffer.
8814If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be excluded. If a
8815selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it will also be
8816selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
8817
8818@noindent
8819If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
8820export.
8821
8822@noindent
8823Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
8824be removed from the export buffer.
8825
8826@node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
b349f79f
CD
8827@section Export options
8828@cindex options, for export
8829
8830@cindex completion, of option keywords
8831The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
8832additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
8833The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
8834C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
8835correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
c8d0cf5c
CD
8836(@pxref{Completion}). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
8837specifically related to export, see @ref{In-buffer settings}.
8838In particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in
8839a separate file which can be included using @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
b349f79f
CD
8840
8841@table @kbd
8842@kindex C-c C-e t
8843@item C-c C-e t
8844Insert template with export options, see example below.
8845@end table
8846
c8d0cf5c
CD
8847@cindex #+TITLE
8848@cindex #+AUTHOR
8849@cindex #+DATE
8850@cindex #+EMAIL
8851@cindex #+DESCRIPTION
8852@cindex #+KEYWORDS
8853@cindex #+LANGUAGE
8854@cindex #+TEXT
8855@cindex #+OPTIONS
8856@cindex #+BIND
8857@cindex #+LINK_UP
8858@cindex #+LINK_HOME
8859@cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS
8860@cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS
8861@cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
8862@vindex user-full-name
8863@vindex user-mail-address
8864@vindex org-export-default-language
8865@example
8866#+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
8867#+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
8868#+DATE: a date, fixed, of a format string for @code{format-time-string}
8869#+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
a351880d
CD
8870#+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g. for the XHTML meta tag
8871#+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g. for the XHTML meta tag
8872#+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g. @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
c8d0cf5c
CD
8873#+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
8874#+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
8875#+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
8876#+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g.: org-export-latex-low-levels itemize
8877 @r{You need to confirm using these, or configure @code{org-export-allow-BIND}}
8878#+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
8879#+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
8880#+LATEX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the LaTeX header, like \usepackage@{xyz@}
864c9740
CD
8881#+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
8882#+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
b349f79f
CD
8883@end example
8884
8885@noindent
8886The OPTIONS line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
8887this way, you can use several OPTIONS lines.} form to specify export settings. Here
8888you can:
8889@cindex headline levels
8890@cindex section-numbers
8891@cindex table of contents
8892@cindex line-break preservation
8893@cindex quoted HTML tags
8894@cindex fixed-width sections
8895@cindex tables
8896@cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
8897@cindex footnotes
8898@cindex special strings
8899@cindex emphasized text
8900@cindex @TeX{} macros
8901@cindex La@TeX{} fragments
8902@cindex author info, in export
8903@cindex time info, in export
8904@example
8905H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
8906num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
8907toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
8908\n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation}
8909@@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
8910:: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
8911|: @r{turn on/off tables}
8912^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
8913 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
8914 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
8915-: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
8916f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
96c8522a
CD
8917todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
8918pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
8919tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
8920<: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
b349f79f
CD
8921*: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
8922TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
8923LaTeX: @r{turn on/off La@TeX{} fragments}
8924skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
8925author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
dd12e1c6 8926creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
b349f79f
CD
8927timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
8928d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers}
8929@end example
c8d0cf5c 8930@noindent
b349f79f
CD
8931These options take effect in both the HTML and La@TeX{} export, except
8932for @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX}, which are respectively @code{t} and
8933@code{nil} for the La@TeX{} export.
8934
8935When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
8936calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
8937settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
c8d0cf5c
CD
8938@code{EXPORT_TEXT}, @code{EXPORT_AUTHOR}, @code{EXPORT_DATE}, and
8939@code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
b349f79f
CD
8940
8941@node The export dispatcher, ASCII export, Export options, Exporting
8942@section The export dispatcher
8943@cindex dispatcher, for export commands
8944
8945All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
8946prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
8947Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
8948contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
8949the subtrees are exported.
4009494e
GM
8950
8951@table @kbd
8952@kindex C-c C-e
8953@item C-c C-e
c8d0cf5c 8954@vindex org-export-run-in-background
4009494e
GM
8955Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
8956listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
64fb801f
CD
8957command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
8958@kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
c8d0cf5c 8959separate Emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
64fb801f 8960the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
b349f79f
CD
8961@kindex C-c C-e v
8962@item C-c C-e v
8963Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
a351880d 8964(i.e. not hidden by outline visibility).
a7808fba
CD
8965@kindex C-u C-u C-c C-e
8966@item C-u C-u C-c C-e
c8d0cf5c 8967@vindex org-export-run-in-background
a7808fba 8968Call an the exporter, but reverse the setting of
a351880d 8969@code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e. request background processing if
c8d0cf5c 8970not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if set.
4009494e
GM
8971@end table
8972
b349f79f 8973@node ASCII export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
4009494e
GM
8974@section ASCII export
8975@cindex ASCII export
8976
c8d0cf5c 8977ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org-mode
4009494e
GM
8978file.
8979
8980@cindex region, active
8981@cindex active region
b6cb4cd5 8982@cindex transient-mark-mode
4009494e
GM
8983@table @kbd
8984@kindex C-c C-e a
8985@item C-c C-e a
c8d0cf5c
CD
8986@cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
8987Export as ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
4009494e 8988will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
c8d0cf5c
CD
8989warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
8990@code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
b349f79f
CD
8991exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
8992current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
4009494e 8993become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
b349f79f 8994@code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
28a16a1b 8995export.
c8d0cf5c
CD
8996@kindex C-c C-e A
8997@item C-c C-e A
8998Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
4009494e
GM
8999@kindex C-c C-e v a
9000@item C-c C-e v a
9001Export only the visible part of the document.
9002@end table
9003
9004@cindex headline levels, for exporting
9005In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
9006headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
9007will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
9008at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
9009
9010@example
9011@kbd{C-1 C-c C-e a}
9012@end example
9013
9014@noindent
9015creates only top level headlines and does the rest as items. When
9016headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
9017the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
a7808fba 9018the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
4009494e
GM
9019the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
9020the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
9021indentation than the first, these are left alone.
9022
c8d0cf5c
CD
9023@vindex org-export-ascii-links-to-notes
9024Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in
9025the text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
9026@code{org-export-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
9027
71d35b24 9028@node HTML export, LaTeX and PDF export, ASCII export, Exporting
4009494e
GM
9029@section HTML export
9030@cindex HTML export
9031
a7808fba 9032Org mode contains an HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
b6cb4cd5 9033HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
4009494e
GM
9034language, but with additional support for tables.
9035
9036@menu
b349f79f 9037* HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
a7808fba 9038* Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
a351880d 9039* Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
c8d0cf5c 9040* Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
55e0839d
CD
9041* Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
9042* Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
a7808fba
CD
9043* CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
9044* Javascript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
4009494e
GM
9045@end menu
9046
9047@node HTML Export commands, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export, HTML export
9048@subsection HTML export commands
9049
9050@cindex region, active
9051@cindex active region
b6cb4cd5 9052@cindex transient-mark-mode
4009494e
GM
9053@table @kbd
9054@kindex C-c C-e h
9055@item C-c C-e h
c8d0cf5c
CD
9056@cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9057Export as HTML file @file{myfile.html}. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
b349f79f 9058the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
c8d0cf5c
CD
9059without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9060@code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
b349f79f
CD
9061exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9062current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
b6cb4cd5 9063title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
b349f79f 9064property, that name will be used for the export.
4009494e
GM
9065@kindex C-c C-e b
9066@item C-c C-e b
9067Export as HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
9068@kindex C-c C-e H
9069@item C-c C-e H
9070Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
9071@kindex C-c C-e R
dbc28aaa 9072@item C-c C-e R
a7808fba
CD
9073Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
9074not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
9075the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
4009494e
GM
9076@kindex C-c C-e v h
9077@kindex C-c C-e v b
9078@kindex C-c C-e v H
9079@kindex C-c C-e v R
9080@item C-c C-e v h
9081@item C-c C-e v b
9082@item C-c C-e v H
9083@item C-c C-e v R
9084Export only the visible part of the document.
9085@item M-x org-export-region-as-html
c8d0cf5c 9086Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was Org-mode
4009494e
GM
9087syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
9088buffer.
9089@item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
c8d0cf5c 9090Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by HTML
4009494e
GM
9091code.
9092@end table
9093
9094@cindex headline levels, for exporting
a7808fba
CD
9095In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
9096defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
9097itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
9098specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
4009494e
GM
9099
9100@example
9101@kbd{C-2 C-c C-e b}
9102@end example
9103
9104@noindent
9105creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
9106
a351880d 9107@node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML Export commands, HTML export
4009494e
GM
9108@subsection Quoting HTML tags
9109
9110Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{&lt;} and
9111@samp{&gt;} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
9112which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
9113@samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
9114simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
9115the exported file use either
9116
c8d0cf5c
CD
9117@cindex #+HTML
9118@cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
4009494e
GM
9119@example
9120#+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
9121@end example
9122
9123@noindent or
b349f79f 9124@cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
4009494e
GM
9125
9126@example
9127#+BEGIN_HTML
9128All lines between these markers are exported literally
9129#+END_HTML
9130@end example
9131
9132
a351880d
CD
9133@node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
9134@subsection Links in HTML export
4009494e
GM
9135
9136@cindex links, in HTML export
9137@cindex internal links, in HTML export
9138@cindex external links, in HTML export
55e0839d 9139Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML. This
c8d0cf5c 9140includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
55e0839d
CD
9141targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
9142the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
9143@file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
9144that an HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
9145path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
9146files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
9147publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
4009494e 9148
44ce9197 9149If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
a50253cc 9150@code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
c8d0cf5c
CD
9151@code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
9152and @code{style} attributes for a link:
44ce9197 9153
c8d0cf5c 9154@cindex #+ATTR_HTML
44ce9197 9155@example
c8d0cf5c
CD
9156#+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org-mode homepage" style="color:red;"
9157[[http://orgmode.org]]
9158@end example
9159
a351880d 9160@node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
c8d0cf5c
CD
9161@subsection Tables
9162@cindex tables, in HTML
9163@vindex org-export-html-table-tag
9164
9165Org-mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
9166@code{org-export-html-table-tag}. The default setting makes tables without
9167cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
9168tables, place somthing like the following before the table:
9169
9170@cindex #+CAPTION
a351880d 9171@cindex #+ATTR_HTML
c8d0cf5c
CD
9172@example
9173#+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
9174#+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="all"
44ce9197
CD
9175@end example
9176
c8d0cf5c 9177@node Images in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
a351880d 9178@subsection Images in HTML export
4009494e
GM
9179
9180@cindex images, inline in HTML
9181@cindex inlining images in HTML
c8d0cf5c 9182@vindex org-export-html-inline-images
a7808fba 9183HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
4009494e 9184it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
c8d0cf5c
CD
9185default@footnote{But see the variable
9186@code{org-export-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
4009494e
GM
9187not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
9188while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
9189@samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
9190itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
9191image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
9192image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
9193will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
9194
9195@example
9196[[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
9197@end example
9198
a351880d
CD
9199If you need to add attributes to an inlines image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
9200In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
9201support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
c8d0cf5c
CD
9202
9203@cindex #+CAPTION
a351880d 9204@cindex #+ATTR_HTML
c8d0cf5c
CD
9205@example
9206#+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
a351880d 9207#+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
c8d0cf5c
CD
9208[[./img/a.jpg]]
9209@end example
9210
4009494e
GM
9211@noindent
9212and you could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
9213
55e0839d 9214@node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Images in HTML export, HTML export
a351880d 9215@subsection Text areas in HTML export
55e0839d
CD
9216
9217@cindex text areas, in HTML
9218An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
9219areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
9220application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
9221@code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
9222label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
9223use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
9224text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
9225respectively. For example
9226
9227@example
9228#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
9229(defun org-xor (a b)
9230 "Exclusive or."
9231 (if a (not b) b))
9232#+END_EXAMPLE
9233@end example
9234
9235
9236@node CSS support, Javascript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
4009494e 9237@subsection CSS support
a7808fba
CD
9238@cindex CSS, for HTML export
9239@cindex HTML export, CSS
4009494e 9240
c8d0cf5c
CD
9241@vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
9242@vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
55e0839d 9243You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
c8d0cf5c
CD
9244assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO
9245keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
9246@code{org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and
9247@code{org-export-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate
9248parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in
9249addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
9250@example
9251p.author @r{author information, including email}
9252p.date @r{publishing date}
9253p.creator @r{creator info, about org-mode version}
9254.title @r{document title}
9255.todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
9256.done @r{the DONE keywords, all stated the count as done}
9257.WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
9258.timestamp @r{timestamp}
9259.timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
9260.timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
9261.tag @r{tag in a headline}
9262._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
9263.target @r{target for links}
9264.linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
9265.code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
9266div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
9267div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
9268.section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
9269div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
9270pre.src @r{formatted source code}
9271pre.example @r{normal example}
9272p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
9273div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
9274p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
9275.footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
9276.footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
9277@end example
9278
9279@vindex org-export-html-style-default
9280@vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
9281@vindex org-export-html-style
9282@vindex org-export-html-extra
9283@vindex org-export-html-style-default
9284Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
e45e3595
CD
9285classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
9286@code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
9287inclusion of these defaults off, customize
9288@code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
9289settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
9290(for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
9291granular settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
9292individually for each file, you can use
4009494e 9293
c8d0cf5c 9294@cindex #+STYLE
4009494e 9295@example
864c9740 9296#+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
4009494e
GM
9297@end example
9298
864c9740 9299@noindent
e45e3595
CD
9300For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
9301directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
9302referring to an external file.
4009494e
GM
9303
9304@c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
9305@c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
9306
a7808fba
CD
9307@node Javascript support, , CSS support, HTML export
9308@subsection Javascript supported display of web pages
9309
c8d0cf5c
CD
9310@cindex Rose, Sebastian
9311Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
a7808fba 9312enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
55e0839d
CD
9313program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
9314is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
a7808fba
CD
9315navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
9316as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
55e0839d
CD
9317view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
9318script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
9319the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
c8d0cf5c 9320We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
55e0839d
CD
9321not want to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
9322copy on your own web server.
a7808fba 9323
b349f79f 9324To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
b6cb4cd5
CD
9325gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
9326customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
9327this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
9328adding a single line to the Org file:
a7808fba 9329
c8d0cf5c 9330@cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
a7808fba 9331@example
b349f79f 9332#+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
a7808fba
CD
9333@end example
9334
9335@noindent
9336If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
9337needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
9338viewing options:
9339
9340@example
9341path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
9342 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
9343 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
b349f79f 9344view: @r{Initial view when website is first shown. Possible values are:}
a7808fba
CD
9345 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
9346 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
9347 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
9348 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
9349sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
9350 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
7006d207
CD
9351 @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
9352 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
c8d0cf5c 9353 @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
a7808fba 9354toc: @r{Should the table of content @emph{initially} be visible?}
c8d0cf5c 9355 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
a7808fba 9356tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
7006d207 9357 @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
c8d0cf5c 9358ftoc: @r{Does the css of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
b349f79f 9359 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
a7808fba 9360ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
c8d0cf5c 9361 @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
a7808fba
CD
9362mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
9363 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
9364buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
9365 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
9366@end example
c8d0cf5c
CD
9367@noindent
9368@vindex org-infojs-options
9369@vindex org-export-html-use-infojs
a7808fba
CD
9370You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
9371@code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
9372pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
9373
c8d0cf5c
CD
9374@node LaTeX and PDF export, DocBook export, HTML export, Exporting
9375@section La@TeX{} and PDF export
9376@cindex La@TeX{} export
71d35b24 9377@cindex PDF export
72d803ad 9378@cindex Guerry, Bastien
4009494e 9379
71d35b24
CD
9380Org mode contains a La@TeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
9381further processing, this backend is also used to produce PDF output. Since
c8d0cf5c 9382the La@TeX{} output uses @file{hyperref} to implement links and cross
71d35b24 9383references, the PDF output file will be fully linked.
4009494e
GM
9384
9385@menu
a50253cc 9386* LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
c8d0cf5c
CD
9387* Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal La@TeX{} code
9388* Sectioning structure:: Changing sectioning in La@TeX{} output
9389* Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to La@TeX{}
9390* Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into La@TeX{} output
4009494e
GM
9391@end menu
9392
71d35b24 9393@node LaTeX/PDF export commands, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX and PDF export, LaTeX and PDF export
c8d0cf5c 9394@subsection La@TeX{} export commands
4009494e 9395
b6cb4cd5
CD
9396@cindex region, active
9397@cindex active region
9398@cindex transient-mark-mode
4009494e
GM
9399@table @kbd
9400@kindex C-c C-e l
9401@item C-c C-e l
c8d0cf5c
CD
9402@cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9403Export as La@TeX{} file @file{myfile.tex}. For an Org file
b349f79f 9404@file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
c8d0cf5c
CD
9405be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
9406requires @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
b6cb4cd5
CD
9407exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9408current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
9409title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
9410property, that name will be used for the export.
4009494e
GM
9411@kindex C-c C-e L
9412@item C-c C-e L
9413Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
9414@kindex C-c C-e v l
9415@kindex C-c C-e v L
9416@item C-c C-e v l
9417@item C-c C-e v L
9418Export only the visible part of the document.
9419@item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
a7808fba 9420Convert the region to La@TeX{} under the assumption that it was Org mode
4009494e
GM
9421syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
9422buffer.
9423@item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
a7808fba 9424Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by La@TeX{}
4009494e 9425code.
71d35b24
CD
9426@kindex C-c C-e p
9427@item C-c C-e p
c8d0cf5c 9428Export as La@TeX{} and then process to PDF.
71d35b24
CD
9429@kindex C-c C-e d
9430@item C-c C-e d
c8d0cf5c 9431Export as La@TeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
4009494e
GM
9432@end table
9433
9434@cindex headline levels, for exporting
c8d0cf5c 9435@vindex org-latex-low-levels
4009494e
GM
9436In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
9437headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
9438will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
9439convert them to a custom string depending on
9440@code{org-latex-low-levels}.
9441
9442If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
a7808fba 9443with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
4009494e
GM
9444
9445@example
9446@kbd{C-2 C-c C-e l}
9447@end example
9448
9449@noindent
9450creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
9451
71d35b24 9452@node Quoting LaTeX code, Sectioning structure, LaTeX/PDF export commands, LaTeX and PDF export
c8d0cf5c 9453@subsection Quoting La@TeX{} code
4009494e 9454
c8d0cf5c 9455Embedded La@TeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded LaTeX}, will be correctly
55e0839d
CD
9456inserted into the La@TeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
9457@samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
9458you can add special code that should only be present in La@TeX{} export with
9459the following constructs:
4009494e 9460
c8d0cf5c
CD
9461@cindex #+LaTeX
9462@cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
4009494e
GM
9463@example
9464#+LaTeX: Literal LaTeX code for export
9465@end example
9466
9467@noindent or
b349f79f 9468@cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
4009494e
GM
9469
9470@example
9471#+BEGIN_LaTeX
9472All lines between these markers are exported literally
9473#+END_LaTeX
9474@end example
dbc28aaa 9475
55e0839d 9476@node Sectioning structure, Tables in LaTeX export, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX and PDF export
dbc28aaa 9477@subsection Sectioning structure
c8d0cf5c
CD
9478@cindex La@TeX{} class
9479@cindex La@TeX{} sectioning structure
dbc28aaa
CD
9480
9481By default, the La@TeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
9482
c8d0cf5c
CD
9483@vindex org-export-latex-default-class
9484@vindex org-export-latex-classes
9485@cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
9486@cindex #+LATEX_CLASS
9487@cindex property, LATEX_CLASS
dbc28aaa 9488You can change this globally by setting a different value for
71d35b24 9489@code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
55e0839d
CD
9490@code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
9491property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
9492The class should be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}, where you can
9493also define the sectioning structure for each class, as well as defining
c8d0cf5c
CD
9494additional classes. You can also use @code{#+LATEX_HEADER:
9495\usepackage@{xyz@}} to add lines to the header.
dbc28aaa 9496
67df9cfb 9497@node Tables in LaTeX export, Images in LaTeX export, Sectioning structure, LaTeX and PDF export
c8d0cf5c
CD
9498@subsection Tables in La@TeX{} export
9499@cindex tables, in La@TeX{} export
67df9cfb 9500
c8d0cf5c 9501For La@TeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label and a caption
a351880d 9502(@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use the @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to
67df9cfb 9503request a longtable environment for the table, so that it may span several
c8d0cf5c 9504pages. Finally, you can set the alignment string:
67df9cfb 9505
c8d0cf5c
CD
9506@cindex #+CAPTION
9507@cindex #+LABEL
9508@cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
67df9cfb
CD
9509@example
9510#+CAPTION: A long table
9511#+LABEL: tbl:long
c8d0cf5c 9512#+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
67df9cfb
CD
9513| ..... | ..... |
9514| ..... | ..... |
9515@end example
9516
9517
9518@node Images in LaTeX export, , Tables in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
c8d0cf5c
CD
9519@subsection Images in La@TeX{} export
9520@cindex images, inline in La@TeX{}
9521@cindex inlining images in La@TeX{}
67df9cfb
CD
9522
9523Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
9524@samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
a351880d 9525output file resulting from La@TeX{} processing. Org will use an
67df9cfb 9526@code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
a351880d
CD
9527caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the figure
9528will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
9529element. You can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify the various
67df9cfb 9530options that can be used in the optional argument of the
a351880d
CD
9531@code{\includegraphics} macro. To modify the placement option of the
9532@code{figure} environment, add something like @samp{placement=[h!]} to the
9533Attributes.
9534
9535If you'd like to let text flow around the image, add the word @samp{wrap} to
9536the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line, which will make the figure occupy the left
9537half of the page. To fine-tune, the @code{placement} field will be the
9538set of additional arguments needed by the @code{wrapfigure} environment.
9539Note that if you change the size of the image, you need to use compatible
9540settings for @code{\includegraphics} and @code{wrapfigure}.
67df9cfb 9541
c8d0cf5c
CD
9542@cindex #+CAPTION
9543@cindex #+LABEL
9544@cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
67df9cfb
CD
9545@example
9546#+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
9547#+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
9548#+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
9549[[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
a351880d
CD
9550
9551#+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement=@{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
9552[[./img/hst.png]]
67df9cfb
CD
9553@end example
9554
55e0839d 9555If you need references to a label created in this way, write
a351880d 9556@samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in La@TeX{}.
67df9cfb 9557
a351880d 9558@node DocBook export, Freemind export, LaTeX and PDF export, Exporting
c8d0cf5c
CD
9559@section DocBook export
9560@cindex DocBook export
9561@cindex PDF export
9562@cindex Cui, Baoqui
9563
9564Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org file is
9565exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to produce other
9566formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many available DocBook
9567tools and stylesheets.
9568
9569Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
9570
9571@menu
9572* DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
9573* Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
9574* Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
9575* Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
9576* Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
9577* Special characters:: How to handle special characters
9578@end menu
9579
9580@node DocBook export commands, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export, DocBook export
9581@subsection DocBook export commands
9582
9583@cindex region, active
9584@cindex active region
9585@cindex transient-mark-mode
9586@table @kbd
9587@kindex C-c C-e D
9588@item C-c C-e D
9589@cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9590Export as DocBook file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the DocBook XML
9591file will be @file{myfile.xml}. The file will be overwritten without
9592warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9593@code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
9594exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9595current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
9596title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
9597property, that name will be used for the export.
9598@kindex C-c C-e V
9599@item C-c C-e V
9600Export as DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
9601
9602@vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command
9603@vindex org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command
9604Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on exported DocBook file, you
9605need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor software installed on your
9606system. Check variables @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} and
9607@code{org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command}.
9608
9609@kindex C-c C-e v D
9610@item C-c C-e v D
9611Export only the visible part of the document.
9612@end table
9613
9614@node Quoting DocBook code, Recursive sections, DocBook export commands, DocBook export
9615@subsection Quoting DocBook code
9616
9617You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into exported
9618DocBook file with the following constructs:
9619
9620@cindex #+DOCBOOK
9621@cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
9622@example
9623#+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
9624@end example
9625
9626@noindent or
9627@cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
9628
9629@example
9630#+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
9631All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
9632literally.
9633#+END_DOCBOOK
9634@end example
9635
9636For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook warning
9637admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay attention to the
9638document context when quoting DocBook code in Org files. You may make
9639exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting DocBook code correctly.
9640
9641@example
9642#+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
9643<warning>
9644 <para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
9645 in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML file may be generated by
9646 DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
9647</warning>
9648#+END_DOCBOOK
9649@end example
9650
9651@node Recursive sections, Tables in DocBook export, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export
9652@subsection Recursive sections
9653@cindex DocBook recursive sections
9654
9655DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the @code{article}
a351880d 9656element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e. @code{section} elements, are
c8d0cf5c
CD
9657used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are exported as
9658top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported as nested
9659sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported completely, no
9660matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
9661
9662Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported DocBook
9663code in other DocBook document types like @code{book} or @code{set}.
9664
9665@node Tables in DocBook export, Images in DocBook export, Recursive sections, DocBook export
9666@subsection Tables in DocBook export
9667@cindex tables, in DocBook export
9668
9669Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been supported since
9670DocBook V4.3.
9671
9672If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated using the
9673@code{informaltable} element; otherwise, a formal table will be generated
9674using the @code{table} element.
9675
9676@node Images in DocBook export, Special characters, Tables in DocBook export, DocBook export
9677@subsection Images in DocBook export
9678@cindex images, inline in DocBook
9679@cindex inlining images in DocBook
9680
9681Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
9682@samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will be exported to DocBook
9683using @code{mediaobject} elements. Each @code{mediaobject} element contains
9684an @code{imageobject} that wraps an @code{imagedata} element. If you have
a351880d 9685specified a caption for an image as described in @ref{Images and tables}, a
c8d0cf5c
CD
9686@code{caption} element will be added in @code{mediaobject}. If a label is
9687also specified, it will be exported as an @code{xml:id} attribute of the
9688@code{mediaobject} element.
9689
9690@vindex org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes
9691Image attributes supported by the @code{imagedata} element, like @code{align}
9692or @code{width}, can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
9693variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} or use the
9694@code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line. Attributes specified in variable
9695@code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} are applied to all inline
9696images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overwritten by image
9697attributes specified in @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} lines).
9698
9699The @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line can be used to specify additional image
9700attributes or overwrite default image attributes for individual images. If
9701the same attribute appears in both the @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line and
9702variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes}, the former
9703overwrites the latter. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
9704set:
9705
9706@cindex #+CAPTION
9707@cindex #+LABEL
9708@cindex #+ATTR_DOCBOOK
9709@example
9710#+CAPTION: The logo of Org mode
9711#+LABEL: unicorn-svg
9712#+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
9713[[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
9714@end example
9715
9716@vindex org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions
9717By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file types:
9718@file{jpeg}, @file{jpg}, @file{png}, @file{gif}, and @file{svg}. You can
9719customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions} to add
9720more types to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
9721
9722@node Special characters, , Images in DocBook export, DocBook export
9723@subsection Special characters in DocBook export
9724@cindex Special characters in DocBook export
9725
9726@vindex org-export-docbook-doctype
9727@vindex org-html-entities
9728Special characters that are written in @TeX{}-like syntax, such as @code{\alpha},
9729@code{\Gamma}, and @code{\Zeta}, are supported by DocBook exporter. These
9730characters are rewritten to XML entities, like @code{&alpha;},
9731@code{&Gamma;}, and @code{&Zeta;}, based on the list saved in variable
9732@code{org-html-entities}. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
9733corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
9734
9735You can customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to include the
9736entities you need. For example, you can set variable
9737@code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to the following value to recognize all
9738special characters included in XHTML entities:
9739
9740@example
9741"<!DOCTYPE article [
9742<!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
9743\"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
9744\"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
9745>
9746%xhtml1-symbol;
9747]>
9748"
9749@end example
9750
a351880d
CD
9751@node Freemind export, XOXO export, DocBook export, Exporting
9752@section Freemind export
9753@cindex Freemind export
9754@cindex mind map
9755
9756The freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
9757
9758@table @kbd
9759@kindex C-c C-e m
9760@item C-c C-e m
9761Export as Freemind mind map @file{myfile.mm}.
9762@end table
9763
9764@node XOXO export, iCalendar export, Freemind export, Exporting
4009494e
GM
9765@section XOXO export
9766@cindex XOXO export
9767
a7808fba 9768Org mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
4009494e 9769Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
c8d0cf5c 9770does not interpret any additional Org-mode features.
4009494e
GM
9771
9772@table @kbd
9773@kindex C-c C-e x
9774@item C-c C-e x
9775Export as XOXO file @file{myfile.html}.
9776@kindex C-c C-e v
9777@item C-c C-e v x
9778Export only the visible part of the document.
9779@end table
9780
b349f79f 9781@node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
4009494e
GM
9782@section iCalendar export
9783@cindex iCalendar export
9784
c8d0cf5c
CD
9785@vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
9786@vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
9787@vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
9788@vindex org-icalendar-categories
9789Some people use Org mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
9790standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
9791case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
9792files in the calendar application. Org mode can export calendar information
9793in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
9794included in the export, configure the variable
9795@code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
9796and TODO items as VTODO. It will also create events from deadlines that are
9797in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
9798to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
9799@code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
9800As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
9801file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
9802configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}.
9803
9804@vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
9805@cindex property, ID
b349f79f
CD
9806The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
9807identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
9808the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
9809@code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
9810entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
9811a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
9812prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
9813In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
9814figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
9815
4009494e
GM
9816@table @kbd
9817@kindex C-c C-e i
9818@item C-c C-e i
9819Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
9820directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
9821@kindex C-c C-e I
9822@item C-c C-e I
c8d0cf5c 9823@vindex org-agenda-files
4009494e
GM
9824Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
9825@code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
9826file will be written.
9827@kindex C-c C-e c
9828@item C-c C-e c
c8d0cf5c 9829@vindex org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file
4009494e
GM
9830Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
9831@code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
9832@code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
9833@end table
9834
c8d0cf5c
CD
9835@vindex org-use-property-inheritance
9836@vindex org-icalendar-include-body
9837@cindex property, SUMMARY
9838@cindex property, DESCRIPTION
9839@cindex property, LOCATION
96c8522a
CD
9840The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
9841property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
9842@code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
9843entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
9844and the description from the body (limited to
28a16a1b 9845@code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
dbc28aaa 9846
c8d0cf5c 9847How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
4009494e
GM
9848you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
9849
4009494e
GM
9850@node Publishing, Miscellaneous, Exporting, Top
9851@chapter Publishing
9852@cindex publishing
c8d0cf5c 9853@cindex O'Toole, David
4009494e 9854
c8d0cf5c
CD
9855Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
9856automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
9857files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
9858pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
9859server.
4009494e 9860
c8d0cf5c
CD
9861You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
9862conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
4009494e 9863
c8d0cf5c 9864Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
4009494e
GM
9865
9866@menu
9867* Configuration:: Defining projects
c8d0cf5c 9868* Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
4009494e
GM
9869* Sample configuration:: Example projects
9870* Triggering publication:: Publication commands
9871@end menu
9872
c8d0cf5c 9873@node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
4009494e
GM
9874@section Configuration
9875
9876Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
9877and many other properties of a project.
9878
9879@menu
9880* Project alist:: The central configuration variable
9881* Sources and destinations:: From here to there
9882* Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
9883* Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
9884* Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
9885* Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
9886* Project page index:: Publishing a list of project files
9887@end menu
9888
9889@node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
9890@subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
9891@cindex org-publish-project-alist
9892@cindex projects, for publishing
9893
c8d0cf5c
CD
9894@vindex org-publish-project-alist
9895Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
9896variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
9897configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
4009494e
GM
9898
9899@lisp
c8d0cf5c 9900 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
28a16a1b 9901@r{or}
c8d0cf5c 9902 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
4009494e
GM
9903
9904@end lisp
9905
c8d0cf5c
CD
9906In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
9907project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
9908publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
9909takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
9910@code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
9911together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
9912a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
9913sequence given.
4009494e
GM
9914
9915@node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
9916@subsection Sources and destinations for files
9917@cindex directories, for publishing
9918
c8d0cf5c
CD
9919Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
9920particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
4009494e
GM
9921and where to put published files.
9922
9923@multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
9924@item @code{:base-directory}
9925@tab Directory containing publishing source files
9926@item @code{:publishing-directory}
c8d0cf5c
CD
9927@tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
9928publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
9929the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
9930use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
4009494e 9931@item @code{:preparation-function}
c8d0cf5c 9932@tab Function called before starting the publishing process, for example, to
4009494e 9933run @code{make} for updating files to be published.
b349f79f 9934@item @code{:completion-function}
c8d0cf5c 9935@tab Function called after finishing the publishing process, for example, to
b349f79f 9936change permissions of the resulting files.
4009494e
GM
9937@end multitable
9938@noindent
9939
9940@node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
9941@subsection Selecting files
9942@cindex files, selecting for publishing
9943
9944By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
9945are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
28a16a1b 9946properties
4009494e
GM
9947@multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
9948@item @code{:base-extension}
9949@tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
c8d0cf5c
CD
9950regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
9951files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
4009494e 9952
28a16a1b 9953@item @code{:exclude}
4009494e
GM
9954@tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
9955published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
9956extension.
9957
9958@item @code{:include}
9959@tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
9960and @code{:exclude}.
9961@end multitable
9962
9963@node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
a7808fba 9964@subsection Publishing action
4009494e
GM
9965@cindex action, for publishing
9966
9967Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
71d35b24
CD
9968possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
9969Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
9970@code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
c8d0cf5c
CD
9971export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
9972@code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}. If you want to publish the Org file itself,
9973but with @i{archived}, @i{commented}, and @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use
9974@code{org-publish-org-to-org} and set the parameters @code{:plain-source}
9975and/or @code{:htmlized-source}. This will produce @file{file.org} and
9976@file{file.org.html} in the publishing
9977directory@footnote{@file{file-source.org} and @file{file-source.org.html} if
9978source and publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of
9979setup, you need to add @code{:exclude "-source\\.org"} to the project
9980definition in @code{org-publish-project-alist} to avoid that the published
9981source files will be considered as new org files the next time the project is
9982published.}. Other files like images only
9983need to be copied to the publishing destination, for this you may use
9984@code{org-publish-attachment}. For non-Org files, you always need to
9985specify the publishing function:
4009494e
GM
9986
9987@multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
9988@item @code{:publishing-function}
9989@tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
9990list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
c8d0cf5c
CD
9991@item @code{:plain-source}
9992@tab Non-nil means, publish plain source.
9993@item @code{:htmlized-source}
9994@tab Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
4009494e
GM
9995@end multitable
9996
c8d0cf5c
CD
9997The function must accept two arguments: a property list containing at least a
9998@code{:publishing-directory} property, and the name of the file to be
9999published. It should take the specified file, make the necessary
4009494e 10000transformation (if any) and place the result into the destination folder.
4009494e
GM
10001
10002@node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
c8d0cf5c 10003@subsection Options for the HTML/La@TeX{} exporters
4009494e
GM
10004@cindex options, for publishing
10005
10006The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
10007and La@TeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
a7808fba 10008variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
4009494e
GM
10009with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
10010respective variable for details.
10011
c8d0cf5c
CD
10012@vindex org-export-html-link-up
10013@vindex org-export-html-link-home
10014@vindex org-export-default-language
10015@vindex org-display-custom-times
10016@vindex org-export-headline-levels
10017@vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
10018@vindex org-export-section-number-format
10019@vindex org-export-with-toc
10020@vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
10021@vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
10022@vindex org-export-with-emphasize
10023@vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
10024@vindex org-export-with-special-strings
10025@vindex org-export-with-footnotes
10026@vindex org-export-with-drawers
10027@vindex org-export-with-tags
10028@vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
10029@vindex org-export-with-priority
10030@vindex org-export-with-TeX-macros
10031@vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
10032@vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
10033@vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
10034@vindex org-export-with-timestamps
10035@vindex org-export-author-info
10036@vindex org-export-creator-info
10037@vindex org-export-with-tables
10038@vindex org-export-highlight-first-table-line
10039@vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
10040@vindex org-export-html-style
10041@vindex org-export-html-style-extra
10042@vindex org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html
10043@vindex org-export-html-inline-images
10044@vindex org-export-html-extension
10045@vindex org-export-html-table-tag
10046@vindex org-export-html-expand
10047@vindex org-export-html-with-timestamp
10048@vindex org-export-publishing-directory
10049@vindex org-export-html-preamble
10050@vindex org-export-html-postamble
10051@vindex org-export-html-auto-preamble
10052@vindex org-export-html-auto-postamble
10053@vindex user-full-name
10054@vindex user-mail-address
10055@vindex org-export-select-tags
10056@vindex org-export-exclude-tags
10057
96c8522a
CD
10058@multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
10059@item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
10060@item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
4009494e 10061@item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
96c8522a 10062@item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
4009494e
GM
10063@item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
10064@item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
96c8522a 10065@item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
4009494e 10066@item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
96c8522a 10067@item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
4009494e
GM
10068@item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
10069@item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
10070@item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
dbc28aaa 10071@item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
96c8522a
CD
10072@item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
10073@item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
10074@item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
10075@item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
10076@item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
4009494e
GM
10077@item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
10078@item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
6eb02347 10079@item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-export-latex-listings}
96c8522a 10080@item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
4009494e 10081@item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
44ce9197
CD
10082@item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
10083@item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
10084@item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
4009494e
GM
10085@item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
10086@item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
e45e3595 10087@item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
4009494e 10088@item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
44ce9197 10089@item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
4009494e
GM
10090@item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
10091@item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
96c8522a 10092@item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
c8d0cf5c 10093@item @code{:xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-export-html-xml-declaration}
96c8522a 10094@item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
4009494e
GM
10095@item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
10096@item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
10097@item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
10098@item @code{:preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
10099@item @code{:postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
10100@item @code{:auto-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-preamble}
10101@item @code{:auto-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-postamble}
10102@item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
c8d0cf5c 10103@item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} : @code{addr;addr;..}
864c9740
CD
10104@item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
10105@item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
c8d0cf5c 10106@item @code{:latex-image-options} @tab @code{org-export-latex-image-default-option}
4009494e
GM
10107@end multitable
10108
10109Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
10110both HTML and La@TeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
10111@code{:LaTeX-fragments}, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
10112La@TeX{} export.
10113
c8d0cf5c 10114@vindex org-publish-project-alist
dbc28aaa
CD
10115When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
10116its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
10117any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
4009494e
GM
10118options}), however, override everything.
10119
10120@node Publishing links, Project page index, Publishing options, Configuration
10121@subsection Links between published files
10122@cindex links, publishing
10123
a7808fba 10124To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
4009494e 10125something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
c8d0cf5c 10126@samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link
4009494e
GM
10127becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
10128pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
c8d0cf5c
CD
10129you publish them to HTML. If you also publish the Org source file and want
10130to link to that, use an @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link,
10131because @code{file:} links are converted to link to the corresponding
10132@file{html} file.
4009494e 10133
c8d0cf5c
CD
10134You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
10135with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
10136the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
10137an example of this usage.
4009494e 10138
c8d0cf5c 10139Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
4009494e 10140only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
28a16a1b 10141location. In this case, use the property
4009494e
GM
10142
10143@multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
10144@item @code{:link-validation-function}
10145@tab Function to validate links
10146@end multitable
10147
10148@noindent
10149to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
10150accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
10151the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
10152function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
10153description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
10154function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
10155file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
10156
10157@node Project page index, , Publishing links, Configuration
10158@subsection Project page index
10159@cindex index, of published pages
10160
10161The following properties may be used to control publishing of an
c8d0cf5c 10162index of files or a summary page for a given project.
4009494e
GM
10163
10164@multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
10165@item @code{:auto-index}
c8d0cf5c
CD
10166@tab When non-nil, publish an index during @code{org-publish-current-project}
10167or @code{org-publish-all}.
4009494e
GM
10168
10169@item @code{:index-filename}
c8d0cf5c
CD
10170@tab Filename for output of index. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
10171becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
4009494e
GM
10172
10173@item @code{:index-title}
10174@tab Title of index page. Defaults to name of file.
10175
10176@item @code{:index-function}
a7808fba 10177@tab Plug-in function to use for generation of index.
4009494e
GM
10178Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-index}, which generates a plain list
10179of links to all files in the project.
10180@end multitable
10181
c8d0cf5c
CD
10182@node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
10183@section Uploading files
10184@cindex rsync
10185@cindex unison
10186
10187For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
10188@command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
10189@i{remote} publishing facilities of Org mode which rely heavily on
10190Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
10191so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
10192under heavy usage.
10193
10194Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
10195to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
10196checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
10197directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
10198@file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
10199
10200Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
10201a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
10202definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
10203files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
10204You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
10205@file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
10206tool syncs them.
10207
10208Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
10209that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
10210@code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
10211benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
10212files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE}. The timestamp mechanism in
10213Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
10214
10215@node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
4009494e
GM
10216@section Sample configuration
10217
10218Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
a7808fba 10219project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
4009494e
GM
10220more complex, with a multi-component project.
10221
10222@menu
10223* Simple example:: One-component publishing
10224* Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
10225@end menu
10226
10227@node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
10228@subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
10229
a7808fba 10230This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
4009494e
GM
10231directory on the local machine.
10232
10233@lisp
10234(setq org-publish-project-alist
28a16a1b 10235 '(("org"
4009494e
GM
10236 :base-directory "~/org/"
10237 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
10238 :section-numbers nil
10239 :table-of-contents nil
e45e3595 10240 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
4009494e 10241 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
c8d0cf5c 10242 type=\"text/css\"/>")))
4009494e
GM
10243@end lisp
10244
10245@node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
10246@subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
10247
10248This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
c8d0cf5c
CD
10249Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
10250style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
4009494e
GM
10251excluded.
10252
10253To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
10254your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
c8d0cf5c 10255paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
4009494e
GM
10256publishable images in @file{~/images}, you'd link to an image with
10257@c
10258@example
10259file:../images/myimage.png
10260@end example
10261@c
10262On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
10263same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
a7808fba 10264right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
4009494e
GM
10265
10266@lisp
10267(setq org-publish-project-alist
10268 '(("orgfiles"
10269 :base-directory "~/org/"
10270 :base-extension "org"
10271 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
10272 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
10273 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
10274 :headline-levels 3
10275 :section-numbers nil
10276 :table-of-contents nil
e45e3595 10277 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
c8d0cf5c 10278 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
4009494e
GM
10279 :auto-preamble t
10280 :auto-postamble nil)
28a16a1b 10281
4009494e
GM
10282 ("images"
10283 :base-directory "~/images/"
10284 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
10285 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
10286 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
28a16a1b 10287
4009494e
GM
10288 ("other"
10289 :base-directory "~/other/"
10290 :base-extension "css\\|el"
10291 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
10292 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
10293 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
10294@end lisp
10295
10296@node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
10297@section Triggering publication
10298
c8d0cf5c 10299Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
4009494e
GM
10300
10301@table @kbd
c8d0cf5c 10302@kindex C-c C-e C
4009494e
GM
10303@item C-c C-e C
10304Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
c8d0cf5c 10305@kindex C-c C-e P
4009494e
GM
10306@item C-c C-e P
10307Publish the project containing the current file.
c8d0cf5c 10308@kindex C-c C-e F
4009494e
GM
10309@item C-c C-e F
10310Publish only the current file.
c8d0cf5c
CD
10311@kindex C-c C-e E
10312@item C-c C-e E
10313Publish every project.
4009494e
GM
10314@end table
10315
c8d0cf5c
CD
10316@vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
10317Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
10318normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
10319publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
10320above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
10321This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
10322@code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
4009494e 10323
c8d0cf5c 10324@node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Publishing, Top
4009494e
GM
10325@chapter Miscellaneous
10326
10327@menu
10328* Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
17673adf 10329* Speed keys:: Electic commands at the beginning of a headline
a7808fba 10330* Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
4009494e
GM
10331* In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
10332* The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
10333* Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
a7808fba 10334* TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
4009494e 10335* Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
4009494e
GM
10336@end menu
10337
c8d0cf5c 10338
17673adf 10339@node Completion, Speed keys, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
4009494e
GM
10340@section Completion
10341@cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
10342@cindex completion, of TODO keywords
10343@cindex completion, of dictionary words
10344@cindex completion, of option keywords
10345@cindex completion, of tags
10346@cindex completion, of property keys
10347@cindex completion, of link abbreviations
10348@cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
10349@cindex TODO keywords completion
10350@cindex dictionary word completion
10351@cindex option keyword completion
10352@cindex tag completion
10353@cindex link abbreviations, completion of
10354
6eb02347
CD
10355Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org-mode uses it whenever it
10356makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
a351880d 10357some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
6eb02347
CD
10358most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
10359@code{org-completion-use-ido}.
10360
a7808fba 10361Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
4009494e
GM
10362not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
10363the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
10364
10365@table @kbd
10366@kindex M-@key{TAB}
10367@item M-@key{TAB}
10368Complete word at point
10369@itemize @bullet
10370@item
10371At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
10372@item
10373After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
10374@item
10375After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
10376can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
10377@item
10378After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
10379from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
10380@samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
10381dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
10382@item
10383After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
10384of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
10385buffer.
10386@item
10387After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
10388@item
10389After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
a7808fba 10390@samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org mode. When the
4009494e
GM
10391option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
10392will insert example settings for this keyword.
10393@item
10394In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
a351880d 10395i.e. valid keys for this line.
4009494e 10396@item
a7808fba 10397Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
4009494e
GM
10398@end itemize
10399@end table
10400
17673adf
CD
10401@node Speed keys, Customization, Completion, Miscellaneous
10402@section Speed keys
10403@cindex speed keys
10404@vindex org-use-speed-commands
10405@vindex org-speed-commands-user
10406
10407Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
10408beginning of a headline, i.e. before the first star. Configure the variable
10409@code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
10410pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
10411variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
10412navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
10413execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a tty,
10414or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
10415
10416To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
10417with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
10418
10419@node Customization, In-buffer settings, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
4009494e
GM
10420@section Customization
10421@cindex customization
10422@cindex options, for customization
10423@cindex variables, for customization
10424
10425There are more than 180 variables that can be used to customize
a7808fba 10426Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
4009494e
GM
10427describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
10428variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
10429@code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
10430settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
10431lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
10432
10433@node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
10434@section Summary of in-buffer settings
10435@cindex in-buffer settings
10436@cindex special keywords
10437
a7808fba 10438Org mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
4009494e
GM
10439per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
10440keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
10441setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
10442lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
10443the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
10444buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
10445activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
10446when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
10447
c8d0cf5c 10448@vindex org-archive-location
4009494e
GM
10449@table @kbd
10450@item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
10451This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
10452all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
10453of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
10454The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
10455@item #+CATEGORY:
10456This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
10457for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
10458end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
10459@item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
c8d0cf5c 10460@cindex property, COLUMNS
4009494e 10461Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
c8d0cf5c 10462columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
dbc28aaa 10463applies.
4009494e 10464@item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
c8d0cf5c
CD
10465@vindex org-table-formula-constants
10466@vindex org-table-formula
4009494e
GM
10467Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
10468line set the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
dbc28aaa 10469The global version of this variable is
4009494e 10470@code{org-table-formula-constants}.
b349f79f
CD
10471@item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
10472Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
10473top-level entries.
dbc28aaa 10474@item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
c8d0cf5c 10475@vindex org-drawers
dbc28aaa
CD
10476Set the file-local set of drawers. The corresponding global variable is
10477@code{org-drawers}.
4009494e 10478@item #+LINK: linkword replace
c8d0cf5c 10479@vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
4009494e
GM
10480These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
10481@xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
10482@code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
10483@item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
c8d0cf5c
CD
10484@vindex org-highest-priority
10485@vindex org-lowest-priority
10486@vindex org-default-priority
4009494e
GM
10487This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
10488must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest priority must
10489have a lower ASCII number that the lowest priority.
10490@item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
10491This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
10492buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
c8d0cf5c 10493@cindex #+SETUPFILE
b349f79f
CD
10494@item #+SETUPFILE: file
10495This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
10496entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
a351880d 10497(i.e. when starting Org mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
b349f79f 10498settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
a50253cc 10499as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
b349f79f
CD
10500any other Org mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
10501cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
4009494e 10502@item #+STARTUP:
c8d0cf5c 10503@cindex #+STARTUP:
a7808fba 10504This line sets options to be used at startup of Org mode, when an
c8d0cf5c
CD
10505Org file is being visited.
10506
10507The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
10508tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
10509@code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
10510@code{overview}.
10511@vindex org-startup-folded
4009494e
GM
10512@cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
10513@cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
10514@cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
7006d207 10515@cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
4009494e 10516@example
7006d207
CD
10517overview @r{top-level headlines only}
10518content @r{all headlines}
10519showall @r{no folding of any entries}
10520showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
4009494e 10521@end example
c8d0cf5c
CD
10522
10523@vindex org-startup-indented
10524@cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
10525@cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
10526Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
10527@code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org-mode 6.29 are required}
10528@example
10529indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
10530noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
10531@end example
10532
10533@vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
4009494e
GM
10534Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
10535is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
10536variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
28a16a1b 10537@code{nil}.
4009494e
GM
10538@cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
10539@cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
10540@example
10541align @r{align all tables}
10542noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
10543@end example
c8d0cf5c
CD
10544@vindex org-log-done
10545@vindex org-log-note-clock-out
10546@vindex org-log-repeat
10547Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
10548configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
10549@code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
4009494e 10550@cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
4009494e 10551@cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
28a16a1b 10552@cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
4009494e 10553@cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
28a16a1b 10554@cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
4009494e 10555@cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
28a16a1b 10556@cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
4009494e 10557@cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
a351880d
CD
10558@cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
10559@cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
10560@cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
10561@cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
10562@cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
10563@cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
4009494e 10564@example
28a16a1b
CD
10565logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
10566lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
10567nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
10568logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
10569lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
10570nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
10571lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
10572nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
a351880d
CD
10573logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
10574lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
10575nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
10576logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
10577lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
10578nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
4009494e 10579@end example
c8d0cf5c
CD
10580@vindex org-hide-leading-stars
10581@vindex org-odd-levels-only
b349f79f
CD
10582Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
10583indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
10584@code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
10585default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
4009494e
GM
10586@cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
10587@cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
10588@cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
10589@cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
10590@example
10591hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
10592showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
b349f79f
CD
10593indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
10594noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
4009494e
GM
10595odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
10596oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
10597@end example
c8d0cf5c
CD
10598@vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
10599@vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
10600To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
4009494e
GM
10601@code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
10602@code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
10603@cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
10604@example
10605customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
10606@end example
c8d0cf5c 10607@vindex constants-unit-system
4009494e
GM
10608The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
10609@code{constants-unit-system}).
10610@cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
10611@cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
10612@example
10613constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
10614constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
10615@end example
c8d0cf5c
CD
10616@vindex org-footnote-define-inline
10617@vindex org-footnote-auto-label
10618@vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
55e0839d 10619To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
c8d0cf5c
CD
10620corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
10621@code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
55e0839d 10622@cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
c8d0cf5c 10623@cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
55e0839d
CD
10624@cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
10625@cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
10626@cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
10627@cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
10628@cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
c8d0cf5c
CD
10629@cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
10630@cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
55e0839d
CD
10631@example
10632fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
10633fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
10634fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
10635fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
10636fnauto @r{create [fn:1]-like labels automatically (default)}
10637fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
10638fnplain @r{create [1]-like labels automatically}
c8d0cf5c
CD
10639fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
10640nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
10641@end example
10642@cindex org-hide-block-startup
10643To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
10644@code{org-hide-block-startup}.
10645@cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
10646@cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
10647@example
10648hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
10649nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
55e0839d 10650@end example
4009494e 10651@item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
c8d0cf5c 10652@vindex org-tag-alist
cad1d376 10653These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
4009494e
GM
10654this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
10655keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
10656@item #+TBLFM:
10657This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
c8d0cf5c
CD
10658@item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,
10659@itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:
10660@itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:
10661@itemx #+LATEX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,
10662@itemx #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
4009494e
GM
10663These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
10664@ref{Export options}.
c8d0cf5c
CD
10665@item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
10666@vindex org-todo-keywords
4009494e 10667These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
c8d0cf5c 10668current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
4009494e
GM
10669@end table
10670
10671@node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
10672@section The very busy C-c C-c key
10673@kindex C-c C-c
10674@cindex C-c C-c, overview
10675
a7808fba 10676The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
4009494e
GM
10677mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
10678this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
c8d0cf5c
CD
10679other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
10680here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
4009494e
GM
10681what this means in different contexts.
10682
10683@itemize @minus
10684@item
10685If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
10686tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
10687@item
10688If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
10689triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
28a16a1b 10690information.
4009494e
GM
10691@item
10692If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
10693works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
10694@item
10695If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
10696the entire table.
10697@item
10698If the cursor is inside a table created by the @file{table.el} package,
10699activate that table.
10700@item
c8d0cf5c 10701If the current buffer is a Remember buffer, close the note and file it.
4009494e
GM
10702With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
10703default location.
10704@item
10705If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
10706corresponding links in this buffer.
10707@item
10708If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
10709drawer, offer property commands.
10710@item
55e0839d
CD
10711If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
10712definition, and vice versa.
10713@item
6eb02347
CD
10714If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
10715@item
4009494e
GM
10716If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
10717of the checkbox.
10718@item
10719If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
10720ordered list.
dbc28aaa 10721@item
c8d0cf5c 10722If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
dbc28aaa 10723block is updated.
4009494e
GM
10724@end itemize
10725
10726@node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
10727@section A cleaner outline view
10728@cindex hiding leading stars
b349f79f
CD
10729@cindex dynamic indentation
10730@cindex odd-levels-only outlines
4009494e
GM
10731@cindex clean outline view
10732
c8d0cf5c
CD
10733Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
10734potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
6eb02347
CD
10735indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
10736where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
10737@emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
4009494e
GM
10738
10739@example
b349f79f
CD
10740@group
10741* Top level headline | * Top level headline
10742** Second level | * Second level
10743*** 3rd level | * 3rd level
10744some text | some text
10745*** 3rd level | * 3rd level
10746more text | more text
10747* Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
10748@end group
4009494e
GM
10749@end example
10750
10751@noindent
6eb02347
CD
10752If you are using at least Emacs 23.1.50.3 and version 6.29 of Org, this kind
10753of view can be achieved dynamically at display time using
10754@code{org-indent-mode}. In this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for
10755display with the necessary amount of space. Also headlines are prefixed with
10756additional stars, so that the amount of indentation shifts by
10757two@footnote{See the variable @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.}
10758spaces per level. All headline stars but the last one are made invisible
10759using the @code{org-hide} face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode}
10760sets @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and
10761@code{org-adapt-indentation} to @code{nil}.} - see below under @samp{2.} for
10762more information on how this works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode}
10763for all files by customizing the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you
10764can turn it on for individual files using
c8d0cf5c
CD
10765
10766@example
10767#+STARTUP: indent
10768@end example
10769
10770If you want a similar effect in earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
10771you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
10772file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
10773the following way:
4009494e 10774
b349f79f 10775@enumerate
96c8522a 10776@item
b349f79f
CD
10777@emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
10778You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
10779with the headline, like
4009494e 10780
b349f79f
CD
10781@example
10782*** 3rd level
10783 more text, now indented
10784@end example
10785
c8d0cf5c
CD
10786@vindex org-adapt-indentation
10787Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
10788editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
10789preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
b349f79f
CD
10790
10791@item
c8d0cf5c 10792@vindex org-hide-leading-stars
b349f79f
CD
10793@emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
10794all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
10795the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
10796with
4009494e
GM
10797
10798@example
4009494e 10799#+STARTUP: hidestars
c8d0cf5c 10800#+STARTUP: showstars
4009494e
GM
10801@end example
10802
b349f79f 10803With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
4009494e
GM
10804
10805@example
b349f79f 10806@group
4009494e
GM
10807* Top level headline
10808 * Second level
10809 * 3rd level
b349f79f
CD
10810 ...
10811@end group
4009494e
GM
10812@end example
10813
10814@noindent
c8d0cf5c
CD
10815@vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
10816The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
10817fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
10818font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
10819have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
10820to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
10821example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
4009494e 10822
b349f79f 10823@item
c8d0cf5c 10824@vindex org-odd-levels-only
b349f79f
CD
10825Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
10826levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
c8d0cf5c
CD
10827to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
10828or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc@.}. In this
10829way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
10830to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
10831correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
10832a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
4009494e
GM
10833
10834@example
10835#+STARTUP: odd
10836#+STARTUP: oddeven
10837@end example
10838
a7808fba 10839You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
4009494e
GM
10840double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
10841RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
10842org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
b349f79f 10843@end enumerate
4009494e
GM
10844
10845@node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
a7808fba
CD
10846@section Using Org on a tty
10847@cindex tty key bindings
4009494e 10848
c8d0cf5c 10849Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
a7808fba 10850Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
dbc28aaa
CD
10851accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
10852@key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
10853together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
10854these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
10855alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
10856more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
c8d0cf5c
CD
10857customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
10858is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
dbc28aaa 10859tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
4009494e 10860
17673adf
CD
10861@multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
10862@item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
10863@item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
10864@item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
10865@item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
10866@item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
10867@item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
10868@item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
10869@item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
10870@item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
10871@item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
10872@item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
10873@item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
10874@item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
10875@item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
10876@item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
10877@item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
10878@item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
10879@item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
10880@item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
4009494e
GM
10881@end multitable
10882
c8d0cf5c
CD
10883
10884@node Interaction, , TTY keys, Miscellaneous
4009494e
GM
10885@section Interaction with other packages
10886@cindex packages, interaction with other
a7808fba 10887Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
4009494e
GM
10888with other code out there.
10889
10890@menu
a7808fba 10891* Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
4009494e
GM
10892* Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
10893@end menu
10894
10895@node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
a7808fba 10896@subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
4009494e
GM
10897
10898@table @asis
10899@cindex @file{calc.el}
c8d0cf5c 10900@cindex Gillespie, Dave
4009494e 10901@item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
a7808fba
CD
10902Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
10903functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
10904checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
c8d0cf5c 10905@code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
a7808fba 10906been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
4009494e 10907distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
a7808fba
CD
10908packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
10909, Embedded Mode, Calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
4009494e 10910@item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
c8d0cf5c
CD
10911@cindex @file{constants.el}
10912@cindex Dominik, Carsten
10913@vindex org-table-formula-constants
4009494e
GM
10914In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
10915names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
10916constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
10917the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
10918and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
c8d0cf5c 10919@samp{Mega}, etc@. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
a7808fba 10920at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
4009494e
GM
10921the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
10922setup. See the installation instructions in the file
10923@file{constants.el}.
10924@item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
10925@cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
c8d0cf5c
CD
10926@cindex Dominik, Carsten
10927Org mode can make use of the CDLa@TeX{} package to efficiently enter
10928La@TeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
dbc28aaa
CD
10929@item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
10930@cindex @file{imenu.el}
a7808fba 10931Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org mode
c8d0cf5c 10932supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
dbc28aaa 10933@lisp
28a16a1b 10934(add-hook 'org-mode-hook
a7808fba 10935 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
dbc28aaa 10936@end lisp
c8d0cf5c
CD
10937@vindex org-imenu-depth
10938By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
dbc28aaa 10939the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
4009494e
GM
10940@item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
10941@cindex @file{remember.el}
c8d0cf5c 10942@cindex Wiegley, John
a7808fba 10943Org cooperates with remember, see @ref{Remember}.
4009494e 10944@file{Remember.el} is not part of Emacs, find it on the web.
dbc28aaa
CD
10945@item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
10946@cindex @file{speedbar.el}
c8d0cf5c 10947@cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
dbc28aaa 10948Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
a7808fba 10949index items in files. Org mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
c8d0cf5c 10950drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
dbc28aaa 10951restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
a7808fba 10952the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
4009494e
GM
10953@cindex @file{table.el}
10954@item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
10955@kindex C-c C-c
10956@cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
10957@cindex @file{table.el}
c8d0cf5c 10958@cindex Ota, Takaaki
4009494e
GM
10959
10960Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and
10961row-spanning, and alignment can be created using the Emacs table
10962package by Takaaki Ota (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table},
10963and also part of Emacs 22).
a7808fba 10964When @key{TAB} or @kbd{C-c C-c} is pressed in such a table, Org mode
4009494e 10965will call @command{table-recognize-table} and move the cursor into the
a7808fba
CD
10966table. Inside a table, the keymap of Org mode is inactive. In order
10967to execute Org mode-related commands, leave the table.
4009494e
GM
10968
10969@table @kbd
10970@kindex C-c C-c
10971@item C-c C-c
10972Recognize @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a
10973table.el table.
10974@c
10975@kindex C-c ~
10976@item C-c ~
c8d0cf5c
CD
10977Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
10978command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org-mode
4009494e
GM
10979format. See the documentation string of the command
10980@code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
10981possible.
10982@end table
10983@file{table.el} is part of Emacs 22.
4009494e 10984@item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
c8d0cf5c
CD
10985@cindex @file{footnote.el}
10986@cindex Baur, Steven L.
55e0839d 10987Org mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
c8d0cf5c 10988However, Org mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
55e0839d 10989which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
4009494e
GM
10990@end table
10991
10992@node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
a7808fba 10993@subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org mode
4009494e
GM
10994
10995@table @asis
10996
3da3282e 10997@cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
c8d0cf5c 10998@vindex org-support-shift-select
3da3282e
CD
10999In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
11000cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
11001This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
11002timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
11003at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
11004special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
c8d0cf5c 11005@code{org-support-shift-select}. Org mode then tries to accommodate shift
3da3282e
CD
11006selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
11007commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
11008cursor moves across a special context.
4009494e 11009
4009494e 11010@item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
c8d0cf5c
CD
11011@cindex @file{CUA.el}
11012@cindex Storm, Kim. F.
11013@vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
3da3282e 11014Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
c8d0cf5c 11015(as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
3da3282e
CD
11016region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
11017@code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
c8d0cf5c 1101823, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
3da3282e 11019if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
c8d0cf5c 11020Org mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
3da3282e
CD
11021Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
11022buffer (but not during date selection).
4009494e
GM
11023
11024@example
3da3282e
CD
11025S-UP -> M-p S-DOWN -> M-n
11026S-LEFT -> M-- S-RIGHT -> M-+
11027C-S-LEFT -> M-S-- C-S-RIGHT -> M-S-+
4009494e
GM
11028@end example
11029
c8d0cf5c 11030@vindex org-disputed-keys
4009494e
GM
11031Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
11032to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
11033@code{org-disputed-keys}.
3da3282e 11034
c8d0cf5c
CD
11035@item @file{yasnippet.el}
11036@cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
11037The way Org-mode binds the TAB key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
11038@code{"\t"}) overrules yasnippets' access to this key. The following code
11039fixed this problem:
11040
11041@lisp
11042(add-hook 'org-mode-hook
11043 (lambda ()
11044 (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
11045 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-group)))
11046@end lisp
11047
4009494e
GM
11048@item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
11049@cindex @file{windmove.el}
c8d0cf5c 11050This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
4009494e
GM
11051in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here.
11052
a351880d
CD
11053@item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
11054@cindex @file{viper.el}
11055@kindex C-c /
11056Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
11057corresponding Org-mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
11058another key for this command, or override the key in
11059@code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
11060
11061@lisp
11062(define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
11063@end lisp
11064
4009494e
GM
11065@end table
11066
7006d207
CD
11067
11068@node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
b349f79f 11069@appendix Hacking
c8d0cf5c 11070@cindex hacking
b349f79f
CD
11071
11072This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
a7808fba 11073Org.
4009494e
GM
11074
11075@menu
c8d0cf5c
CD
11076* Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
11077* Add-on packages:: Available extensions
4009494e 11078* Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
c8d0cf5c
CD
11079* Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
11080* Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for La@TeX{} and other programs
4009494e
GM
11081* Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
11082* Special agenda views:: Customized views
c8d0cf5c 11083* Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
4009494e 11084* Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
b349f79f 11085* Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
4009494e
GM
11086@end menu
11087
c8d0cf5c
CD
11088@node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
11089@section Hooks
11090@cindex hooks
11091
11092Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
11093functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
11094use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
11095maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
11096@uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
11097
11098@node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
11099@section Add-on packages
11100@cindex add-on packages
11101
11102A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
11103These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
11104packages with the separate release available at the Org mode home page at
11105@uref{http://orgmode.org}. The list of contributed packages, along with
11106documentation about each package, is maintained by the Worg project at
11107@uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
11108
11109
11110
11111@node Adding hyperlink types, Context-sensitive commands, Add-on packages, Hacking
4009494e
GM
11112@section Adding hyperlink types
11113@cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
11114
a7808fba 11115Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
c8d0cf5c
CD
11116(@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
11117provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
11118@file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
a7808fba 11119@samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
c8d0cf5c 11120Emacs:
4009494e
GM
11121
11122@lisp
a7808fba 11123;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
4009494e
GM
11124
11125(require 'org)
11126
11127(org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
11128(add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
11129
11130(defcustom org-man-command 'man
11131 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
11132 :group 'org-link
11133 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
11134
11135(defun org-man-open (path)
11136 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
11137PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
11138 (funcall org-man-command path))
11139
11140(defun org-man-store-link ()
11141 "Store a link to a manpage."
11142 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
11143 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
11144 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
11145 (link (concat "man:" page))
11146 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
11147 (org-store-link-props
11148 :type "man"
11149 :link link
11150 :description description))))
11151
11152(defun org-man-get-page-name ()
11153 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
11154 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
11155 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
11156 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
11157 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
11158
11159(provide 'org-man)
11160
11161;;; org-man.el ends here
11162@end lisp
11163
11164@noindent
11165You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
11166
11167@lisp
11168(require 'org-man)
11169@end lisp
11170
11171@noindent
864c9740 11172Let's go through the file and see what it does.
4009494e 11173@enumerate
28a16a1b 11174@item
4009494e
GM
11175It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
11176loaded.
11177@item
11178The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
11179with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
11180that will be called to follow such a link.
11181@item
c8d0cf5c 11182@vindex org-store-link-functions
4009494e
GM
11183The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
11184order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
11185buffer displaying a man page.
11186@end enumerate
11187
11188The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
c8d0cf5c 11189First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
a7808fba 11190command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
4009494e 11191@code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
c8d0cf5c 11192defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
4009494e
GM
11193path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
11194value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
11195
11196Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
c8d0cf5c 11197to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
4009494e 11198try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
c8d0cf5c 11199create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
4009494e 11200of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
a7808fba
CD
11201return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
11202manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
4009494e
GM
11203@samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
11204and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
11205can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
a7808fba 11206the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
4009494e
GM
11207buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
11208
c8d0cf5c 11209When is makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
a351880d 11210@code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g. completion)
c8d0cf5c
CD
11211support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
11212not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
11213
11214@node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
11215@section Context-sensitive commands
11216@cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
11217@cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
11218@vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
11219
11220Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
11221important example it the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
11222Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
11223
11224Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
11225special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
11226the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
11227allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language. For
11228this package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
11229@code{#+RR:}.
11230
11231@lisp
11232(defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
11233 "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
11234 (if (save-excursion
11235 (beginning-of-line 1)
11236 (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
11237 (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
11238 t) ;; to signal that we took action
11239 nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
11240
11241(add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
11242@end lisp
11243
11244The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
11245case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
11246signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
11247contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
11248
11249
11250@node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
a7808fba 11251@section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
4009494e 11252@cindex tables, in other modes
dbc28aaa 11253@cindex lists, in other modes
a7808fba 11254@cindex Orgtbl mode
4009494e 11255
a7808fba 11256Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
4009494e 11257frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
dbc28aaa
CD
11258specific languages, for example La@TeX{}. However, this is extremely
11259hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
c8d0cf5c 11260and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl-mode table
dbc28aaa
CD
11261editor.
11262
4009494e 11263
a7808fba 11264This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
4009494e
GM
11265table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
11266function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
11267@i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
11268the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
11269for a very flexible system.
11270
dbc28aaa
CD
11271Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists. You can use Org's
11272facilities to edit and structure lists by turning @code{orgstruct-mode}
11273on, then locally exporting such lists in another format (HTML, La@TeX{}
a7808fba 11274or Texinfo.)
dbc28aaa
CD
11275
11276
4009494e 11277@menu
6eb02347 11278* Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
4009494e
GM
11279* A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
11280* Translator functions:: Copy and modify
a7808fba 11281* Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
4009494e
GM
11282@end menu
11283
11284@node Radio tables, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
11285@subsection Radio tables
11286@cindex radio tables
11287
11288To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
11289lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
a7808fba 11290Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
4009494e
GM
11291between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
11292
11293@example
11294/* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
11295/* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
11296@end example
11297
11298@noindent
11299Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
a7808fba 11300Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
4009494e 11301example:
c8d0cf5c 11302@cindex #+ORGTBL
4009494e
GM
11303@example
11304#+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
11305@end example
11306
11307@noindent
11308@code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
11309in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
11310that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
11311arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
11312passed as a property list to the translation function for
11313interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
11314acted upon before the translation function is called:
11315
11316@table @code
11317@item :skip N
b349f79f
CD
11318Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
11319this parameter!
11320
4009494e
GM
11321@item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
11322List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
11323calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
11324Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
11325removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
11326additional columns.
11327@end table
11328
11329@noindent
11330The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
11331without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
11332compilation of a C file or processing of a La@TeX{} file. There are a
11333number of different solutions:
11334
11335@itemize @bullet
11336@item
11337The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
a7808fba 11338language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
4009494e 11339@samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
28a16a1b 11340@item
4009494e 11341Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
c8d0cf5c 11342statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
4009494e
GM
11343in La@TeX{}.
11344@item
c8d0cf5c 11345You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
4009494e 11346the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
c8d0cf5c
CD
11347only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment}
11348makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
4009494e
GM
11349key.
11350@end itemize
11351
11352@node A LaTeX example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
c8d0cf5c
CD
11353@subsection A La@TeX{} example of radio tables
11354@cindex La@TeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
4009494e
GM
11355
11356The best way to wrap the source table in La@TeX{} is to use the
11357@code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
11358activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
a7808fba
CD
11359header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
11360default this works only for La@TeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
4009494e
GM
11361variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
11362modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
55e0839d 11363be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
4009494e
GM
11364will then get the following template:
11365
c8d0cf5c 11366@cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
4009494e
GM
11367@example
11368% BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
11369% END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
11370\begin@{comment@}
11371#+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
11372| | |
11373\end@{comment@}
11374@end example
11375
11376@noindent
c8d0cf5c 11377@vindex La@TeX{}-verbatim-environments
a7808fba 11378The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
4009494e
GM
11379@code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into La@TeX{} and to put it
11380into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
11381fill in the table, feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
11382the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
c8d0cf5c 11383this may cause problems with font-lock in La@TeX{} mode. As shown in the
4009494e
GM
11384example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
11385@code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
c8d0cf5c 11386expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
4009494e
GM
11387much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
11388variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
11389
11390@example
11391% BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
11392% END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
11393\begin@{comment@}
11394#+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
11395| Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
11396|-------+------+---------+---------|
11397| Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
11398| Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
11399| March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
11400#+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
11401% $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
11402\end@{comment@}
11403@end example
11404
11405@noindent
11406When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
11407table inserted between the two marker lines.
11408
55e0839d 11409Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
c8d0cf5c
CD
11410want to control how columns are aligned, etc@. In this case we make sure
11411that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
a351880d 11412table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e. to not produce
4009494e
GM
11413header and footer commands of the target table:
11414
11415@example
11416\begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
11417Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
11418% BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
11419% END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
11420\end@{tabular@}
11421%
11422\begin@{comment@}
11423#+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
11424| Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
11425|-------+------+---------+---------|
11426| Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
11427| Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
11428| March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
11429#+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
11430\end@{comment@}
11431@end example
11432
11433The La@TeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
a7808fba 11434Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
4009494e 11435and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
c8d0cf5c 11436interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
4009494e
GM
11437
11438@table @code
11439@item :splice nil/t
11440When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
11441tabular environment. Default is nil.
11442
11443@item :fmt fmt
c8d0cf5c 11444A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
4009494e
GM
11445original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
11446you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
11447column numbers and formats. for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
a7808fba
CD
11448A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
11449function must return a formatted string.
4009494e
GM
11450
11451@item :efmt efmt
11452Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
11453have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
11454@code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
11455may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
11456@code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
11457@code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
a7808fba
CD
11458applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
11459supplied instead of strings.
4009494e
GM
11460@end table
11461
dbc28aaa 11462@node Translator functions, Radio lists, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
4009494e 11463@subsection Translator functions
a7808fba 11464@cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
4009494e
GM
11465@cindex translator function
11466
b349f79f
CD
11467Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
11468(comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
11469@code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
11470Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
11471code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
11472translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
11473itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
11474@code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
c8d0cf5c 11475hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
4009494e
GM
11476
11477@lisp
11478@group
11479(defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
a7808fba 11480 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
4009494e
GM
11481 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
11482 org-table-last-alignment ""))
11483 (params2
11484 (list
11485 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
11486 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
11487 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
11488 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
11489 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
11490@end group
11491@end lisp
11492
11493As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
11494@var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
a351880d 11495(variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e. the
4009494e
GM
11496ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
11497would like to use the La@TeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
11498be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
11499overrule the default with
11500
11501@example
11502#+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
11503@end example
11504
11505For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
11506analogy with the La@TeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
11507directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
11508with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
c8d0cf5c 11509started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
4009494e
GM
11510separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
11511a single line!):
11512
11513@example
11514#+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
11515 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
11516@end example
11517
11518@noindent
11519Please check the documentation string of the function
11520@code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
c8d0cf5c 11521that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
4009494e
GM
11522@code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
11523using the generic function.
11524
11525Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
11526things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
11527two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
11528line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
11529argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
11530@samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
11531containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
c8d0cf5c 11532translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
4009494e
GM
11533others can benefit from your work.
11534
dbc28aaa
CD
11535@node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
11536@subsection Radio lists
11537@cindex radio lists
11538@cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
11539
6eb02347
CD
11540Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way than sending and
11541receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
11542insert radio lists templates in HTML, La@TeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
11543@code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
dbc28aaa
CD
11544
11545Here are the differences with radio tables:
11546
11547@itemize @minus
11548@item
11549Use @code{ORGLST} instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
11550@item
11551The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
11552parameters.
28a16a1b 11553@item
c8d0cf5c 11554@kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
dbc28aaa
CD
11555@end itemize
11556
11557Here is a La@TeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
11558La@TeX{} file:
11559
c8d0cf5c 11560@cindex #+ORGLIST
dbc28aaa
CD
11561@example
11562% BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
11563% END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
11564\begin@{comment@}
11565#+ORGLIST: SEND to-buy orgtbl-to-latex
11566- a new house
11567- a new computer
11568 + a new keyboard
11569 + a new mouse
11570- a new life
11571\end@{comment@}
11572@end example
11573
11574Pressing `C-c C-c' on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
11575La@TeX{} list between the two marker lines.
11576
b349f79f 11577@node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
4009494e
GM
11578@section Dynamic blocks
11579@cindex dynamic blocks
11580
a7808fba 11581Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
4009494e
GM
11582specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
11583A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
11584command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
11585
11586Dynamic block are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
11587to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
11588the content of the block.
11589
b349f79f 11590#+BEGIN:dynamic block
4009494e
GM
11591@example
11592#+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
11593
11594#+END:
11595@end example
11596
11597Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
11598
11599@table @kbd
11600@kindex C-c C-x C-u
11601@item C-c C-x C-u
11602Update dynamic block at point.
11603@kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
11604@item C-u C-c C-x C-u
11605Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
11606@end table
11607
11608Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
11609END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
28a16a1b
CD
11610writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
11611to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
11612extra parameter @code{:content}.
11613
11614For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
4009494e
GM
11615@code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
11616with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
11617of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
11618run:
11619
11620@example
11621#+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
11622
11623#+END:
11624@end example
11625
11626@noindent
11627The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
11628
11629@lisp
11630(defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
11631 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
11632 (insert "Last block update at: "
11633 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
11634@end lisp
11635
11636If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
11637you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
11638example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
c8d0cf5c 11639written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
a7808fba 11640@code{org-mode}.
4009494e 11641
c8d0cf5c 11642@node Special agenda views, Extracting agenda information, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
a7808fba 11643@section Special agenda views
4009494e
GM
11644@cindex agenda views, user-defined
11645
a7808fba 11646Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the
4009494e
GM
11647selection made by any of the agenda views. You may specify a function
11648that is used at each match to verify if the match should indeed be part
11649of the agenda view, and if not, how much should be skipped.
11650
11651Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
11652tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
a7808fba
CD
11653marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
11654PROJECT. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
4009494e
GM
11655PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
11656the subtree belonging to the project line.
11657
11658To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
11659the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
11660indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
11661tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
11662search should continue from there.
11663
11664@lisp
11665(defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
11666 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
11667 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
dbc28aaa 11668 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
4009494e
GM
11669 nil ; tag found, do not skip
11670 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
11671@end lisp
11672
11673Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
11674like this:
11675
11676@lisp
11677(org-add-agenda-custom-command
11678 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
e45e3595 11679 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
4009494e
GM
11680 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
11681@end lisp
11682
c8d0cf5c 11683@vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
4009494e
GM
11684Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
11685meaningful header in the agenda view.
11686
c8d0cf5c
CD
11687@vindex org-odd-levels-only
11688@vindex org-agenda-skip-function
a7808fba
CD
11689A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
11690entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
c8d0cf5c
CD
11691your custom search function, simply do a search for
11692@samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
11693level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
11694stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
11695you really want to have.
a7808fba 11696
4009494e
GM
11697You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
11698particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
11699and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
11700
11701@table @code
11702@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
11703Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
11704@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
11705Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
11706@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
11707Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
11708@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
11709Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
c8d0cf5c
CD
11710@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
11711Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
4009494e 11712@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'regexp "regular expression")
dbc28aaa
CD
11713Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
11714@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'notregexp "regular expression")
11715Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
4009494e
GM
11716@item '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
11717Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
11718@end table
11719
11720Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
11721like this, even without defining a special function:
11722
11723@lisp
11724(org-add-agenda-custom-command
11725 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
11726 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
dbc28aaa 11727 'regexp ":waiting:"))
4009494e
GM
11728 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
11729@end lisp
11730
c8d0cf5c
CD
11731@node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Special agenda views, Hacking
11732@section Extracting agenda information
11733@cindex agenda, pipe
11734@cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
11735
11736@vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
11737Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
11738line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
11739directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
11740processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
11741@code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
11742ASCII text to STDOUT. The command takes a single string as parameter.
11743If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
11744you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
11745key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
11746current TODO list, you could use
11747
11748@example
11749emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
11750@end example
11751
11752If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
11753tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
11754(all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
11755@samp{NewYork}), you could use
11756
11757@example
11758emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
11759 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
11760@end example
11761
11762@noindent
11763You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
11764
11765@example
11766emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
11767 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
11768 org-agenda-ndays 30 \
11769 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
11770 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
11771 | lpr
11772@end example
11773
11774@noindent
11775which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
11776@file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
11777
11778If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
11779can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
11780list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
11781contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
11782are:
11783
11784@example
11785category @r{The category of the item}
11786head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
11787type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
11788 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
11789 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
11790 diary @r{imported from diary}
11791 deadline @r{a deadline}
11792 scheduled @r{scheduled}
11793 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
11794 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
11795 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
11796 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
11797 block @r{entry has date block including date}
11798todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
11799tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
11800date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
11801time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
11802extra @r{String with extra planning info}
11803priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
11804priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
11805@end example
11806
11807@noindent
11808Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
11809led to the selection of the item.
11810
11811A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
11812For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
11813Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
11814
11815@example
11816#!/usr/bin/perl
11817
11818# define the Emacs command to run
11819$cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
11820
11821# run it and capture the output
11822$agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
11823
11824# loop over all lines
11825foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
11826 # get the individual values
11827 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
11828 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
11829 # process and print
11830 print "[ ] $head\n";
11831@}
11832@end example
11833
c8d0cf5c 11834@node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
4009494e
GM
11835@section Using the property API
11836@cindex API, for properties
11837@cindex properties, API
11838
11839Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
11840properties.
11841
11842@defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
c8d0cf5c 11843Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
4009494e
GM
11844This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
11845scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
11846entry. The return value is an alist, keys may occur multiple times
c8d0cf5c 11847if the property key was used several times.@*
4009494e
GM
11848POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
11849If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
11850`special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
11851@end defun
c8d0cf5c 11852@vindex org-use-property-inheritance
4009494e 11853@defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
a7808fba
CD
11854Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM. By default,
11855this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
11856is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
11857higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
11858@code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
11859@code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
4009494e
GM
11860@end defun
11861
11862@defun org-entry-delete pom property
11863Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
11864@end defun
11865
11866@defun org-entry-put pom property value
11867Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
11868@end defun
11869
11870@defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
11871Get all property keys in the current buffer.
11872@end defun
11873
11874@defun org-insert-property-drawer
11875Insert a property drawer at point.
11876@end defun
11877
864c9740
CD
11878@defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
11879Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES. VALUES should be a list of
11880strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
11881@end defun
11882
11883@defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
11884Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
11885values and return the values as a list of strings.
11886@end defun
11887
a7808fba
CD
11888@defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
11889Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
11890values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
11891@end defun
11892
11893@defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
11894Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
11895values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
11896@end defun
11897
11898@defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
11899Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
11900values and check if VALUE is in this list.
11901@end defun
11902
b349f79f
CD
11903@node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
11904@section Using the mapping API
11905@cindex API, for mapping
11906@cindex mapping entries, API
11907
11908Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
11909certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
11910views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
11911functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
96c8522a 11912is:
b349f79f
CD
11913
11914@defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
11915Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
11916
c8d0cf5c 11917FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called without
b349f79f
CD
11918arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
11919The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
11920returned as a list.
11921
c8d0cf5c
CD
11922The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so FUNC
11923does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor will be
11924moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
11925processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some
11926circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results. For example,
a351880d 11927if you have removed (e.g. archived) the current (sub)tree it could
c8d0cf5c
CD
11928mean that the next entry will be skipped entirely. In such cases, you
11929can specify the position from where search should continue by making
11930FUNC set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer
11931position.
11932
864c9740 11933MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
b349f79f
CD
11934Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
11935the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
11936visited by the iteration.
11937
11938SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
11939
11940@example
11941nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
11942tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
11943file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
11944file-with-archives
11945 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
11946agenda @r{all agenda files}
11947agenda-with-archives
11948 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
11949(file1 file2 ...)
11950 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
11951@end example
c8d0cf5c 11952@noindent
b349f79f
CD
11953The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
11954the scanner. The following items can be given here:
11955
c8d0cf5c 11956@vindex org-agenda-skip-function
b349f79f
CD
11957@example
11958archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
11959comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
11960function or Lisp form
11961 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
867d4bb3 11962 @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
b349f79f
CD
11963 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
11964 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
11965@end example
11966@end defun
11967
11968The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
a50253cc
GM
11969It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
11970information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
b349f79f 11971Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
96c8522a 11972
b349f79f
CD
11973@defun org-todo &optional arg
11974Change the TODO state of the entry, see the docstring of the functions for
11975the many possible values for the argument ARG.
11976@end defun
11977
11978@defun org-priority &optional action
11979Change the priority of the entry, see the docstring of this function for the
11980possible values for ACTION.
11981@end defun
11982
11983@defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
11984Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
11985or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
11986@end defun
11987
11988@defun org-promote
11989Promote the current entry.
11990@end defun
11991
11992@defun org-demote
11993Demote the current entry.
11994@end defun
11995
11996Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
11997a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
11998Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
11999
12000@lisp
12001(org-map-entries
12002 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
12003 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
12004@end lisp
12005
12006The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
12007@code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
12008
12009@lisp
96c8522a 12010(length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
b349f79f
CD
12011@end lisp
12012
7006d207
CD
12013@node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
12014@appendix MobileOrg
12015@cindex iPhone
12016@cindex MobileOrg
12017
12018@i{MobileOrg} is an application for the @i{iPhone/iPod Touch} series of
a351880d
CD
12019devices, developed by Richard Moreland. @i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing
12020and capture support for an Org-mode system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It
12021does also allow you to record changes to existing entries. For information
12022about @i{MobileOrg}, see @uref{http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/}).
7006d207
CD
12023
12024This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
12025format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
a351880d
CD
12026captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
12027
12028For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
12029customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tags-alist} to
12030cover all important tags and todo keywords, even if individual files use only
12031part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
12032in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of todo state
12033@i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
12034(@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
7006d207
CD
12035
12036@menu
12037* Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
12038* Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
12039* Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
12040@end menu
12041
12042@node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
12043@section Setting up the staging area
12044
12045Org-mode has commands to prepare a directory with files for @i{MobileOrg},
12046and to read captured notes from there. If Emacs can directly write to the
a351880d
CD
12047WebDAV directory accessed by @i{MobileOrg}, just point to this directory
12048using the variable @code{org-mobile-directory}. Using the @file{tramp}
12049method, @code{org-mobile-directory} may point to a remote directory
12050accessible through, for example,
12051@file{ssh/scp}:
12052
12053@smallexample
12054(setq org-mobile-directory "/scpc:user@@remote.host:org/webdav/")
12055@end smallexample
12056
12057If Emacs cannot access the WebDAV directory directly using a @file{tramp}
12058method, or you prefer to maintain a local copy, you can use a local directory
12059for staging. Other means must then be used to keep this directory in sync
12060with the WebDAV directory. In the following example, files are staged in
12061@file{~/stage}, and Org-mode hooks take care of moving files to and from the
12062WebDAV directory using @file{scp}.
12063
12064@smallexample
7006d207
CD
12065(setq org-mobile-directory "~/stage/")
12066(add-hook 'org-mobile-post-push-hook
a351880d 12067 (lambda () (shell-command "scp -r ~/stage/* user@@wdhost:mobile/")))
7006d207 12068(add-hook 'org-mobile-pre-pull-hook
a351880d 12069 (lambda () (shell-command "scp user@@wdhost:mobile/mobileorg.org ~/stage/ ")))
7006d207 12070(add-hook 'org-mobile-post-pull-hook
a351880d
CD
12071 (lambda () (shell-command "scp ~/stage/mobileorg.org user@@wdhost:mobile/")))
12072@end smallexample
7006d207
CD
12073
12074@node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
12075@section Pushing to MobileOrg
12076
12077This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
12078to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
12079all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
a351880d
CD
12080can be included by customizing @code{org-mobiles-files}. File names will be
12081staged with path relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
12082inside this directory. The push operation also creates (in the same
12083directory) a special Org file @file{agendas.org}. This file is an Org-mode
12084style outline, containing every custom agenda view defined by the user.
12085While creating the agendas, Org-mode will force@footnote{See the variable
12086@code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items}.} an ID property on all entries
12087referenced by the agendas, so that these entries can be uniquely identified
12088if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for further action. Finally, Org writes the file
12089@file{index.org}, containing links to all other files. If @i{MobileOrg} is
12090configured to request this file from the WebDAV server, all agendas and Org
12091files will be downloaded to the device. To speed up the download, MobileOrg
12092will only read files whose checksums@footnote{stored automatically in the
12093file @file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
7006d207
CD
12094
12095@node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
12096@section Pulling from MobileOrg
12097
12098When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the WebDAV server, it not only pulls the
12099Org files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to
a351880d
CD
12100flagged and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server.
12101Org has a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an
12102inbox file and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it
12103works:
7006d207
CD
12104
12105@enumerate
12106@item
12107Org moves all entries found in
12108@file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
12109operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
a351880d
CD
12110@code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
12111will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
12112@item
12113After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
12114@i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
12115interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
12116text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
12117action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
12118again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
12119pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
12120message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
7006d207
CD
12121@item
12122Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
12123should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
12124If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
12125will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
12126agenda line.
12127@table @kbd
12128@kindex ?
12129@item ?
12130Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
12131another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
12132z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
12133Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
12134@code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
a351880d
CD
12135in a property). In this way you indicate, that the intended processing for
12136this flagged entry is finished.
7006d207
CD
12137@end table
12138@end enumerate
12139
12140@kindex C-c a ?
12141If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
12142return to this agenda view using @kbd{C-c a ?}. Note, however, that there is
12143a subtle difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x
12144org-mobile-pull RET} is guaranteed to search all files that have been
12145addressed by the last pull. This might include a file that is not currently
12146in your list of agenda files. If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate
12147the view, only the current agenda files will be searched.
12148
12149@node History and Acknowledgments, Main Index, MobileOrg, Top
4009494e 12150@appendix History and Acknowledgments
a351880d 12151@cindex acknowledgements
4009494e
GM
12152@cindex history
12153@cindex thanks
12154
c8d0cf5c 12155Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface
a7808fba 12156of the Emacs Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and
4009494e
GM
12157projects, and using Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However,
12158having to remember eleven different commands with two or three keys per
a7808fba 12159command, only to hide and show parts of the outline tree, that seemed
4009494e 12160entirely unacceptable to me. Also, when using outlines to take notes, I
c8d0cf5c 12161constantly wanted to restructure the tree, organizing it parallel to my
4009494e
GM
12162thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility cycling} and @emph{structure
12163editing} were originally implemented in the package
12164@file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
12165@file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project
c8d0cf5c
CD
12166planning, the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic
12167@emph{timestamps}, and @emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main
12168goals that Org still has today: to be a new, outline-based,
4009494e
GM
12169plain text mode with innovative and intuitive editing features, and to
12170incorporate project planning functionality directly into a notes file.
12171
a50253cc 12172A special thanks goes to @i{Bastien Guerry} who has not only written a large
a7808fba 12173number of extensions to Org (most of them integrated into the core by now),
c8d0cf5c 12174but who has also helped in the development and maintenance of Org so much that he
7ddb1b5f 12175should be considered the main co-contributor to this package.
a7808fba 12176
c8d0cf5c
CD
12177Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
12178@email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
4009494e
GM
12179reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
12180Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
12181trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
a7808fba 12182in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
4009494e
GM
12183complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
12184let me know.
12185
12186@itemize @bullet
12187
12188@item
12189@i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
12190@item
a7808fba 12191@i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
4009494e 12192@item
b349f79f
CD
12193@i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
12194Org-mode website.
12195@item
c8d0cf5c
CD
12196@i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
12197@item
12198@i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org-mode files.
12199@item
12200@i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
4009494e
GM
12201@item
12202@i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
12203for Remember.
12204@item
12205@i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
12206specified time.
12207@item
c8d0cf5c 12208@i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
4009494e
GM
12209calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
12210@file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
12211@item
c8d0cf5c
CD
12212@i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
12213@item
12214@i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter.
4009494e 12215@item
a351880d
CD
12216@i{Dan Davison} wrote (together with @i{Eric Schulte}) Org Babel.
12217@item
5fbc0f11 12218@i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
4009494e
GM
12219came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
12220them.
12221@item
c8d0cf5c
CD
12222@i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
12223@item
4009494e
GM
12224@i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
12225inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
12226asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
12227@item
a7808fba 12228@i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format,
4009494e
GM
12229patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and inspired the agenda.
12230@item
12231@i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
12232HTML agendas.
12233@item
12234@i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
12235@item
28a16a1b
CD
12236@i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
12237@item
4009494e
GM
12238@i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
12239around a match in a hidden outline tree.
12240@item
a351880d
CD
12241@i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
12242@item
12243@i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
12244@item
12245@i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
12246@item
dbc28aaa 12247@i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
4009494e 12248@item
a7808fba
CD
12249@i{Bastien Guerry} wrote the La@TeX{} exporter and @file{org-bibtex.el}, and
12250has been prolific with patches, ideas, and bug reports.
4009494e
GM
12251@item
12252@i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
12253@item
a7808fba
CD
12254@i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
12255task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
c8d0cf5c 12256been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
a7808fba 12257@item
c8d0cf5c 12258@i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
864c9740
CD
12259patches.
12260@item
a7808fba
CD
12261@i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
12262@item
4009494e
GM
12263@i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
12264folded entries, and column view for properties.
12265@item
a7808fba
CD
12266@i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
12267@item
4009494e
GM
12268@i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded La@TeX{} and tested it. He also
12269provided frequent feedback and some patches.
12270@item
55e0839d
CD
12271@i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
12272invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
12273@item
4009494e
GM
12274@i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
12275@item
dbc28aaa
CD
12276@i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
12277@item
4009494e
GM
12278@i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
12279basis.
12280@item
12281@i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
12282happy.
12283@item
7006d207
CD
12284@i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
12285@item
c8d0cf5c
CD
12286@i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
12287and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
4009494e 12288@item
c8d0cf5c
CD
12289@i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
12290@item
12291@i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
4009494e
GM
12292@item
12293@i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
12294file links, and TAGS.
12295@item
12296@i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
12297into Japanese.
12298@item
12299@i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
12300@item
12301@i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
12302links, among other things.
12303@item
12304@i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
12305provided frequent feedback.
12306@item
c8d0cf5c
CD
12307@i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
12308into bundles of 20 for undo.
12309@item
4009494e
GM
12310@i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
12311@item
12312@i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
12313control.
12314@item
a351880d
CD
12315@i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
12316also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
55e0839d 12317@item
4009494e
GM
12318@i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
12319@item
a7808fba 12320@i{Sebastian Rose} wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
c8d0cf5c
CD
12321webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
12322single-key navigation.
a7808fba 12323@item
4009494e
GM
12324@i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
12325conflict with @file{allout.el}.
12326@item
c8d0cf5c 12327@i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
b349f79f 12328extensive patches.
4009494e 12329@item
b349f79f
CD
12330@i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
12331of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
4009494e
GM
12332@item
12333@i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
12334other things.
12335@item
a351880d
CD
12336@i{Eric Schulte} wrote @file{org-plot.el} and (together with @i{Dan Davison})
12337Org Babel, and contributed various patches, small features and modules.
864c9740 12338@item
b349f79f 12339Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
4009494e
GM
12340@file{organizer-mode.el}.
12341@item
55e0839d
CD
12342@i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
12343examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
a7808fba 12344@item
64fb801f
CD
12345@i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
12346now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
12347@item
4009494e
GM
12348@i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
12349subtrees.
12350@item
12351@i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
12352@item
864c9740
CD
12353@i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
12354tweaks and features.
12355@item
b349f79f
CD
12356@i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
12357extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
4009494e 12358@item
96c8522a
CD
12359@i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
12360with links transformation to Org syntax.
12361@item
4009494e
GM
12362@i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
12363chapter about publishing.
12364@item
12365@i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
12366in HTML output.
12367@item
12368@i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
12369keyword.
12370@item
12371@i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
12372system.
12373@item
b349f79f 12374@i{John Wiegley} wrote @file{emacs-wiki.el}, @file{planner.el}, and
7ddb1b5f
CD
12375@file{muse.el}, which have some overlap with Org. Initially the development
12376of Org was fully independent because I was not aware of the existence of
12377these packages. But with time I have occasionally looked at John's code and
12378learned a lot from it. John has also contributed a number of great ideas and
12379patches directly to Org, including the attachment system
12380(@file{org-attach.el}), integration with Apple Mail
a351880d
CD
12381(@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical dependencies of TODO items, habit
12382tracking (@file{org-habits.el}) and support for pcomplete.
4009494e
GM
12383@item
12384@i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
a7808fba 12385linking to Gnus.
4009494e 12386@item
a7808fba 12387@i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
4009494e
GM
12388work on a tty.
12389@item
12390@i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
12391and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
12392@end itemize
12393
12394
dbc28aaa 12395@node Main Index, Key Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
c8d0cf5c 12396@unnumbered Concept Index
4009494e
GM
12397
12398@printindex cp
12399
c8d0cf5c 12400@node Key Index, Variable Index, Main Index, Top
4009494e
GM
12401@unnumbered Key Index
12402
12403@printindex ky
12404
c8d0cf5c
CD
12405@node Variable Index, , Key Index, Top
12406@unnumbered Variable Index
12407
12408This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
12409mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
a351880d 12410org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
c8d0cf5c
CD
12411
12412@printindex vr
12413
4009494e
GM
12414@bye
12415
12416@ignore
a7808fba 12417 arch-tag: 7893d1Fe-cc57-4d13-b5e5-f494a1CBC7ac
4009494e 12418@end ignore
a7808fba
CD
12419
12420@c Local variables:
12421@c ispell-local-dictionary: "en_US-w_accents"
12422@c ispell-local-pdict: "./.aspell.org.pws"
12423@c fill-column: 77
12424@c End:
44ce9197 12425
7006d207
CD
12426
12427@c LocalWords: webdavhost pre